1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */ 2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H 3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H 4 /* 5 * 802.11 device and configuration interface 6 * 7 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH 9 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 10 * Copyright (C) 2018-2021, 2023 Intel Corporation 11 */ 12 13 #include <linux/ethtool.h> 14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h> 15 #include <linux/netdevice.h> 16 #include <linux/debugfs.h> 17 #include <linux/list.h> 18 #include <linux/bug.h> 19 #include <linux/netlink.h> 20 #include <linux/skbuff.h> 21 #include <linux/nl80211.h> 22 #include <linux/if_ether.h> 23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h> 24 #include <linux/net.h> 25 #include <linux/rfkill.h> 26 #include <net/regulatory.h> 27 28 /** 29 * DOC: Introduction 30 * 31 * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges 32 * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated 33 * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used 34 * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent 35 * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers 36 * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely. 37 * 38 * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum 39 * use restrictions. 40 */ 41 42 43 /** 44 * DOC: Device registration 45 * 46 * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device 47 * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs 48 * described below. 49 * 50 * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each 51 * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each 52 * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with 53 * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's 54 * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes 55 * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the 56 * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating 57 * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the 58 * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful. 59 * 60 * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has 61 * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and 62 * structures here describe these capabilities in detail. 63 */ 64 65 struct wiphy; 66 67 /* 68 * wireless hardware capability structures 69 */ 70 71 /** 72 * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags 73 * 74 * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code. 75 * 76 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled. 77 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes 78 * sending probe requests or beaconing. 79 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) is set for this 80 * channel. 81 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel. 82 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel 83 * is not permitted. 84 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel 85 * is not permitted. 86 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel. 87 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band, 88 * this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this 89 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 90 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 91 * restrictions. 92 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band, 93 * this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this 94 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 95 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 96 * restrictions. 97 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY 98 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT 99 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 100 * on this channel. 101 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 102 * on this channel. 103 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel. 104 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted 105 * on this channel. 106 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted 107 * on this channel. 108 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted 109 * on this channel. 110 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted 111 * on this channel. 112 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted 113 * on this channel. 114 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ: If the driver supports 320 MHz on the band, 115 * this flag indicates that a 320 MHz channel cannot use this 116 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 117 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 118 * restrictions. 119 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not permitted on this channel. 120 */ 121 enum ieee80211_channel_flags { 122 IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED = 1<<0, 123 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR = 1<<1, 124 IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD = 1<<2, 125 IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR = 1<<3, 126 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS = 1<<4, 127 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS = 1<<5, 128 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM = 1<<6, 129 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ = 1<<7, 130 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ = 1<<8, 131 IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY = 1<<9, 132 IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT = 1<<10, 133 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ = 1<<11, 134 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ = 1<<12, 135 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE = 1<<13, 136 IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ = 1<<14, 137 IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ = 1<<15, 138 IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ = 1<<16, 139 IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ = 1<<17, 140 IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ = 1<<18, 141 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ = 1<<19, 142 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT = 1<<20, 143 }; 144 145 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \ 146 (IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS) 147 148 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS 60000 149 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS (30 * 60 * 1000) 150 151 /** 152 * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition 153 * 154 * This structure describes a single channel for use 155 * with cfg80211. 156 * 157 * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz 158 * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz 159 * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel 160 * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags. 161 * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory 162 * code to support devices with additional restrictions 163 * @band: band this channel belongs to. 164 * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi 165 * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm) 166 * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm) 167 * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon 168 * has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon() 169 * to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band. 170 * @orig_mag: internal use 171 * @orig_mpwr: internal use 172 * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required 173 * on this channel. 174 * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 175 * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels. 176 * @psd: power spectral density (in dBm) 177 */ 178 struct ieee80211_channel { 179 enum nl80211_band band; 180 u32 center_freq; 181 u16 freq_offset; 182 u16 hw_value; 183 u32 flags; 184 int max_antenna_gain; 185 int max_power; 186 int max_reg_power; 187 bool beacon_found; 188 u32 orig_flags; 189 int orig_mag, orig_mpwr; 190 enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state; 191 unsigned long dfs_state_entered; 192 unsigned int dfs_cac_ms; 193 s8 psd; 194 }; 195 196 /** 197 * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags 198 * 199 * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured 200 * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for 201 * different bands/PHY modes. 202 * 203 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short 204 * preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and 205 * with CCK rates. 206 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 207 * when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the 208 * core code when registering the wiphy. 209 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 210 * when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 211 * core code when registering the wiphy. 212 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 213 * when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 214 * core code when registering the wiphy. 215 * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode. 216 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode 217 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode 218 */ 219 enum ieee80211_rate_flags { 220 IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<0, 221 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A = 1<<1, 222 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B = 1<<2, 223 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G = 1<<3, 224 IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G = 1<<4, 225 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ = 1<<5, 226 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ = 1<<6, 227 }; 228 229 /** 230 * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter 231 * 232 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS 233 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS 234 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS 235 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS 236 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type 237 */ 238 enum ieee80211_bss_type { 239 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS, 240 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS, 241 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 242 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS, 243 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY 244 }; 245 246 /** 247 * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter 248 * 249 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set 250 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear 251 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting 252 */ 253 enum ieee80211_privacy { 254 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON, 255 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF, 256 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY 257 }; 258 259 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x) \ 260 ((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF) 261 262 /** 263 * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition 264 * 265 * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can 266 * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short 267 * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are 268 * passed around. 269 * 270 * @flags: rate-specific flags from &enum ieee80211_rate_flags 271 * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps 272 * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate 273 * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when 274 * short preamble is used 275 */ 276 struct ieee80211_rate { 277 u32 flags; 278 u16 bitrate; 279 u16 hw_value, hw_value_short; 280 }; 281 282 /** 283 * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse 284 * 285 * @enable: is the feature enabled. 286 * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element. 287 * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset 288 * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use 289 * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use 290 * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by 291 * members of the SRG 292 * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values 293 * used by members of the SRG 294 */ 295 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd { 296 bool enable; 297 u8 sr_ctrl; 298 u8 non_srg_max_offset; 299 u8 min_offset; 300 u8 max_offset; 301 u8 bss_color_bitmap[8]; 302 u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8]; 303 }; 304 305 /** 306 * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring 307 * 308 * @color: the current color. 309 * @enabled: HE BSS color is used 310 * @partial: define the AID equation. 311 */ 312 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color { 313 u8 color; 314 bool enabled; 315 bool partial; 316 }; 317 318 /** 319 * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities 320 * 321 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 322 * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA. 323 * 324 * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA 325 * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec 326 * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor 327 * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing 328 * @mcs: Supported MCS rates 329 */ 330 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap { 331 u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */ 332 bool ht_supported; 333 u8 ampdu_factor; 334 u8 ampdu_density; 335 struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs; 336 }; 337 338 /** 339 * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities 340 * 341 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 342 * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA. 343 * 344 * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA 345 * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec 346 * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates 347 */ 348 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap { 349 bool vht_supported; 350 u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */ 351 struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs; 352 }; 353 354 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 25 355 356 /** 357 * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities 358 * 359 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 360 * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA. 361 * 362 * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid. 363 * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element. 364 * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations. 365 * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data. 366 */ 367 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap { 368 bool has_he; 369 struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem; 370 struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp; 371 u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN]; 372 }; 373 374 /** 375 * struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp - EHT max supported NSS per MCS 376 * 377 * See P802.11be_D1.3 Table 9-401k - "Subfields of the Supported EHT-MCS 378 * and NSS Set field" 379 * 380 * @only_20mhz: MCS/NSS support for 20 MHz-only STA. 381 * @bw: MCS/NSS support for 80, 160 and 320 MHz 382 * @bw._80: MCS/NSS support for BW <= 80 MHz 383 * @bw._160: MCS/NSS support for BW = 160 MHz 384 * @bw._320: MCS/NSS support for BW = 320 MHz 385 */ 386 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp { 387 union { 388 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_20mhz_only only_20mhz; 389 struct { 390 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _80; 391 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _160; 392 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _320; 393 } __packed bw; 394 } __packed; 395 } __packed; 396 397 #define IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 32 398 399 /** 400 * struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap - STA's EHT capabilities 401 * 402 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 403 * to describe 802.11be EHT capabilities for a STA. 404 * 405 * @has_eht: true iff EHT data is valid. 406 * @eht_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the eht capabilities element. 407 * @eht_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations. 408 * @eht_ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data. 409 */ 410 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap { 411 bool has_eht; 412 struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem_fixed eht_cap_elem; 413 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp eht_mcs_nss_supp; 414 u8 eht_ppe_thres[IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN]; 415 }; 416 417 /* sparse defines __CHECKER__; see Documentation/dev-tools/sparse.rst */ 418 #ifdef __CHECKER__ 419 /* 420 * This is used to mark the sband->iftype_data pointer which is supposed 421 * to be an array with special access semantics (per iftype), but a lot 422 * of code got it wrong in the past, so with this marking sparse will be 423 * noisy when the pointer is used directly. 424 */ 425 # define __iftd __attribute__((noderef, address_space(__iftype_data))) 426 #else 427 # define __iftd 428 #endif /* __CHECKER__ */ 429 430 /** 431 * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type 432 * 433 * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the 434 * interface types defined in @types_mask. Each type in the 435 * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data. 436 * 437 * @types_mask: interface types mask 438 * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities 439 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a 440 * 6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value). 441 * @eht_cap: STA's EHT capabilities 442 * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise 443 * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data 444 * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length 445 */ 446 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data { 447 u16 types_mask; 448 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap; 449 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa; 450 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap; 451 struct { 452 const u8 *data; 453 unsigned int len; 454 } vendor_elems; 455 }; 456 457 /** 458 * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations 459 * 460 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz 461 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz 462 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz 463 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz 464 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 465 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 466 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 467 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and 468 * 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 469 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 470 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 471 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 472 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 473 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 474 * and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 475 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz, 476 * 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 477 */ 478 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config { 479 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4 = 4, 480 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5 = 5, 481 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6 = 6, 482 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7 = 7, 483 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8 = 8, 484 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9 = 9, 485 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10 = 10, 486 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11 = 11, 487 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12 = 12, 488 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13 = 13, 489 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14 = 14, 490 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15 = 15, 491 }; 492 493 /** 494 * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration 495 * 496 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 497 * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration 498 * 499 * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s) 500 * that are allowed to be used for transmissions. 501 * Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc. 502 * Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported. 503 * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes 504 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations 505 */ 506 struct ieee80211_edmg { 507 u8 channels; 508 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config; 509 }; 510 511 /** 512 * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities 513 * 514 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 515 * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA. 516 * 517 * @s1g: is STA an S1G STA 518 * @cap: S1G capabilities information 519 * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set 520 */ 521 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap { 522 bool s1g; 523 u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */ 524 u8 nss_mcs[5]; 525 }; 526 527 /** 528 * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition 529 * 530 * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy 531 * is able to operate in. 532 * 533 * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with 534 * in this band. 535 * @band: the band this structure represents 536 * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels 537 * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with 538 * in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported 539 * rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM. 540 * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates 541 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band 542 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band 543 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band 544 * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band 545 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course) 546 * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries 547 * @iftype_data: interface type data entries. Note that the bits in 548 * @types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only 549 * one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of 550 * iftype_data). 551 */ 552 struct ieee80211_supported_band { 553 struct ieee80211_channel *channels; 554 struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates; 555 enum nl80211_band band; 556 int n_channels; 557 int n_bitrates; 558 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; 559 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; 560 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap; 561 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap; 562 u16 n_iftype_data; 563 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data __iftd *iftype_data; 564 }; 565 566 /** 567 * _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array 568 * @sband: the sband to initialize 569 * @iftd: the iftype data array pointer 570 * @n_iftd: the length of the iftype data array 571 * 572 * Set the sband iftype data array; use this where the length cannot 573 * be derived from the ARRAY_SIZE() of the argument, but prefer 574 * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data() where it can be used. 575 */ 576 static inline void 577 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 578 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftd, 579 u16 n_iftd) 580 { 581 sband->iftype_data = (const void __iftd __force *)iftd; 582 sband->n_iftype_data = n_iftd; 583 } 584 585 /** 586 * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array 587 * @sband: the sband to initialize 588 * @iftd: the iftype data array 589 */ 590 #define ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd) \ 591 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd, ARRAY_SIZE(iftd)) 592 593 /** 594 * for_each_sband_iftype_data - iterate sband iftype data entries 595 * @sband: the sband whose iftype_data array to iterate 596 * @i: iterator counter 597 * @iftd: iftype data pointer to set 598 */ 599 #define for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, iftd) \ 600 for (i = 0, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i]; \ 601 i < (sband)->n_iftype_data; \ 602 i++, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i]) 603 604 /** 605 * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype 606 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 607 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 608 * 609 * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found 610 */ 611 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data * 612 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 613 u8 iftype) 614 { 615 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data; 616 int i; 617 618 if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX)) 619 return NULL; 620 621 if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN) 622 iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP; 623 624 for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, data) { 625 if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype)) 626 return data; 627 } 628 629 return NULL; 630 } 631 632 /** 633 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype 634 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 635 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 636 * 637 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found 638 */ 639 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * 640 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 641 u8 iftype) 642 { 643 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 644 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 645 646 if (data && data->he_cap.has_he) 647 return &data->he_cap; 648 649 return NULL; 650 } 651 652 /** 653 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities 654 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 655 * @iftype: the iftype to search for 656 * 657 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities 658 */ 659 static inline __le16 660 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 661 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 662 { 663 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 664 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 665 666 if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he)) 667 return 0; 668 669 return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa; 670 } 671 672 /** 673 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap - return ETH capabilities for an sband's iftype 674 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 675 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 676 * 677 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or NULL is none found 678 */ 679 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap * 680 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 681 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 682 { 683 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 684 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 685 686 if (data && data->eht_cap.has_eht) 687 return &data->eht_cap; 688 689 return NULL; 690 } 691 692 /** 693 * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree 694 * 695 * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for 696 * 697 * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful 698 * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board 699 * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier). 700 * 701 * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable 702 * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with 703 * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make 704 * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified 705 * without affecting other devices. 706 * 707 * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev. 708 * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first. 709 * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register(). 710 */ 711 #ifdef CONFIG_OF 712 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy); 713 #else /* CONFIG_OF */ 714 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy) 715 { 716 } 717 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */ 718 719 720 /* 721 * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods 722 */ 723 724 /** 725 * DOC: Actions and configuration 726 * 727 * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration 728 * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these 729 * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these 730 * operations use are described separately. 731 * 732 * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status 733 * information via some functions that drivers need to call. 734 * 735 * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described 736 * in a separate chapter. 737 */ 738 739 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\ 740 WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN) 741 742 /** 743 * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters 744 * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise 745 * %MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set 746 * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames 747 * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface. 748 * If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may 749 * determine the address as needed. 750 * This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the 751 * %NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag. Others may support creating 752 ** only p2p devices with specified MAC. 753 * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets 754 * belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed 755 * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring 756 * MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed 757 */ 758 struct vif_params { 759 u32 flags; 760 int use_4addr; 761 u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN]; 762 const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups; 763 const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr; 764 }; 765 766 /** 767 * struct key_params - key information 768 * 769 * Information about a key 770 * 771 * @key: key material 772 * @key_len: length of key material 773 * @cipher: cipher suite selector 774 * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used 775 * with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian, 776 * length given by @seq_len. 777 * @seq_len: length of @seq. 778 * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero) 779 * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX) 780 */ 781 struct key_params { 782 const u8 *key; 783 const u8 *seq; 784 int key_len; 785 int seq_len; 786 u16 vlan_id; 787 u32 cipher; 788 enum nl80211_key_mode mode; 789 }; 790 791 /** 792 * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition 793 * @chan: the (control) channel 794 * @width: channel width 795 * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment 796 * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment 797 * (only with 80+80 MHz) 798 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration. 799 * If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero), 800 * chan will define the primary channel and all other 801 * parameters are ignored. 802 * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz 803 */ 804 struct cfg80211_chan_def { 805 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 806 enum nl80211_chan_width width; 807 u32 center_freq1; 808 u32 center_freq2; 809 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 810 u16 freq1_offset; 811 }; 812 813 /* 814 * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control 815 */ 816 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask { 817 struct { 818 u32 legacy; 819 u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN]; 820 u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX]; 821 u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX]; 822 enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi; 823 enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi; 824 enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf; 825 } control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 826 }; 827 828 829 /** 830 * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration 831 * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration 832 * of the peer. 833 * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify 834 * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed, 835 * similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp. 836 * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID 837 * @retry_long: retry count value 838 * @retry_short: retry count value 839 * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation 840 * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS 841 * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation 842 * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type 843 * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID 844 */ 845 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg { 846 bool config_override; 847 u8 tids; 848 u64 mask; 849 enum nl80211_tid_config noack; 850 u8 retry_long, retry_short; 851 enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu; 852 enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts; 853 enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu; 854 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type; 855 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask; 856 }; 857 858 /** 859 * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration 860 * @peer: Station's MAC address 861 * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied 862 * @tid_conf: Configuration change info 863 */ 864 struct cfg80211_tid_config { 865 const u8 *peer; 866 u32 n_tid_conf; 867 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[] __counted_by(n_tid_conf); 868 }; 869 870 /** 871 * struct cfg80211_fils_aad - FILS AAD data 872 * @macaddr: STA MAC address 873 * @kek: FILS KEK 874 * @kek_len: FILS KEK length 875 * @snonce: STA Nonce 876 * @anonce: AP Nonce 877 */ 878 struct cfg80211_fils_aad { 879 const u8 *macaddr; 880 const u8 *kek; 881 u8 kek_len; 882 const u8 *snonce; 883 const u8 *anonce; 884 }; 885 886 /** 887 * struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp - enable/disable HW timestamping 888 * @macaddr: peer MAC address. NULL to enable/disable HW timestamping for all 889 * addresses. 890 * @enable: if set, enable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address. 891 * Otherwise disable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address. 892 */ 893 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp { 894 const u8 *macaddr; 895 bool enable; 896 }; 897 898 /** 899 * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef 900 * @chandef: the channel definition 901 * 902 * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given 903 * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion. 904 */ 905 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type 906 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 907 { 908 switch (chandef->width) { 909 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 910 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 911 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 912 return NL80211_CHAN_HT20; 913 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 914 if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq) 915 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS; 916 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS; 917 default: 918 WARN_ON(1); 919 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 920 } 921 } 922 923 /** 924 * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type 925 * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill 926 * @channel: the control channel 927 * @chantype: the channel type 928 * 929 * Given a channel type, create a channel definition. 930 */ 931 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 932 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 933 enum nl80211_channel_type chantype); 934 935 /** 936 * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical 937 * @chandef1: first channel definition 938 * @chandef2: second channel definition 939 * 940 * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are 941 * identical, %false otherwise. 942 */ 943 static inline bool 944 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 945 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2) 946 { 947 return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan && 948 chandef1->width == chandef2->width && 949 chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 && 950 chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset && 951 chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2); 952 } 953 954 /** 955 * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel 956 * 957 * @chandef: the channel definition 958 * 959 * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise. 960 */ 961 static inline bool 962 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 963 { 964 return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config; 965 } 966 967 /** 968 * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible 969 * @chandef1: first channel definition 970 * @chandef2: second channel definition 971 * 972 * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible, 973 * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise. 974 */ 975 const struct cfg80211_chan_def * 976 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 977 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2); 978 979 /** 980 * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid 981 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 982 * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise. 983 */ 984 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 985 986 /** 987 * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used 988 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 989 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 990 * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set 991 * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise. 992 */ 993 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy, 994 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 995 u32 prohibited_flags); 996 997 /** 998 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required 999 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 1000 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 1001 * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype 1002 * Returns: 1003 * 1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error 1004 */ 1005 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1006 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 1007 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 1008 1009 /** 1010 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable - checks if chandef is DFS usable and we 1011 * can/need start CAC on such channel 1012 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 1013 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 1014 * 1015 * Return: true if all channels available and at least 1016 * one channel requires CAC (NL80211_DFS_USABLE) 1017 */ 1018 bool cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1019 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 1020 1021 /** 1022 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time - get the DFS CAC time (in ms) for given 1023 * channel definition 1024 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 1025 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 1026 * 1027 * Returns: DFS CAC time (in ms) which applies for this channel definition 1028 */ 1029 unsigned int 1030 cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1031 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 1032 1033 /** 1034 * nl80211_send_chandef - sends the channel definition. 1035 * @msg: the msg to send channel definition 1036 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 1037 * 1038 * Returns: 0 if sent the channel definition to msg, < 0 on error 1039 **/ 1040 int nl80211_send_chandef(struct sk_buff *msg, const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 1041 1042 /** 1043 * ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags - return rate flags for channel width 1044 * @width: the channel width of the channel 1045 * 1046 * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK 1047 * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels. 1048 * 1049 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel width 1050 */ 1051 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags 1052 ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width) 1053 { 1054 switch (width) { 1055 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 1056 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ; 1057 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 1058 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ; 1059 default: 1060 break; 1061 } 1062 return 0; 1063 } 1064 1065 /** 1066 * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel 1067 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 1068 * 1069 * See ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(). 1070 * 1071 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel 1072 */ 1073 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags 1074 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 1075 { 1076 return ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(chandef->width); 1077 } 1078 1079 /** 1080 * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef 1081 * 1082 * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel 1083 * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual 1084 * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels. 1085 * 1086 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 1087 * 1088 * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef 1089 */ 1090 static inline int 1091 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 1092 { 1093 switch (chandef->width) { 1094 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 1095 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6, 1096 chandef->chan->max_power); 1097 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 1098 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3, 1099 chandef->chan->max_power); 1100 default: 1101 break; 1102 } 1103 return chandef->chan->max_power; 1104 } 1105 1106 /** 1107 * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels 1108 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for 1109 * @band_mask: which bands to check on 1110 * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable, 1111 * %IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account 1112 */ 1113 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1114 unsigned long band_mask, 1115 u32 prohibited_flags); 1116 1117 /** 1118 * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags 1119 * 1120 * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in 1121 * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used 1122 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in 1123 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in 1124 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in 1125 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in 1126 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in 1127 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in 1128 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in 1129 * 1130 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info 1131 * it has filled in during the get_survey(). 1132 */ 1133 enum survey_info_flags { 1134 SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM = BIT(0), 1135 SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE = BIT(1), 1136 SURVEY_INFO_TIME = BIT(2), 1137 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY = BIT(3), 1138 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY = BIT(4), 1139 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX = BIT(5), 1140 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX = BIT(6), 1141 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN = BIT(7), 1142 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX = BIT(8), 1143 }; 1144 1145 /** 1146 * struct survey_info - channel survey response 1147 * 1148 * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single 1149 * record to report global statistics 1150 * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags 1151 * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are 1152 * optional 1153 * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel) 1154 * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy 1155 * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy 1156 * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data 1157 * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data 1158 * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning 1159 * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS 1160 * 1161 * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information. 1162 * 1163 * This structure can later be expanded with things like 1164 * channel duty cycle etc. 1165 */ 1166 struct survey_info { 1167 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 1168 u64 time; 1169 u64 time_busy; 1170 u64 time_ext_busy; 1171 u64 time_rx; 1172 u64 time_tx; 1173 u64 time_scan; 1174 u64 time_bss_rx; 1175 u32 filled; 1176 s8 noise; 1177 }; 1178 1179 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES 10 1180 1181 /** 1182 * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings 1183 * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled 1184 * (from enum nl80211_wpa_versions) 1185 * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset) 1186 * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers 1187 * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites 1188 * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites 1189 * @akm_suites: AKM suites 1190 * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 1191 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 1192 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 1193 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 1194 * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be 1195 * allowed through even on unauthorized ports 1196 * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port 1197 * protocol frames. 1198 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 1199 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 1200 * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control 1201 * port for mac80211 1202 * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload) 1203 * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE 1204 * offload) 1205 * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload) 1206 * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation: 1207 * 1208 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED 1209 * Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any 1210 * preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in 1211 * such a scenario. 1212 * 1213 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK 1214 * Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only 1215 * 1216 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT 1217 * Allow hash-to-element only 1218 * 1219 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH 1220 * Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element 1221 */ 1222 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings { 1223 u32 wpa_versions; 1224 u32 cipher_group; 1225 int n_ciphers_pairwise; 1226 u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES]; 1227 int n_akm_suites; 1228 u32 akm_suites[CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES]; 1229 bool control_port; 1230 __be16 control_port_ethertype; 1231 bool control_port_no_encrypt; 1232 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 1233 bool control_port_no_preauth; 1234 const u8 *psk; 1235 const u8 *sae_pwd; 1236 u8 sae_pwd_len; 1237 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe; 1238 }; 1239 1240 /** 1241 * struct cfg80211_mbssid_config - AP settings for multi bssid 1242 * 1243 * @tx_wdev: pointer to the transmitted interface in the MBSSID set 1244 * @index: index of this AP in the multi bssid group. 1245 * @ema: set to true if the beacons should be sent out in EMA mode. 1246 */ 1247 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config { 1248 struct wireless_dev *tx_wdev; 1249 u8 index; 1250 bool ema; 1251 }; 1252 1253 /** 1254 * struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems - Multiple BSSID elements 1255 * 1256 * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems. 1257 * 1258 * @elem: Array of multiple BSSID element(s) to be added into Beacon frames. 1259 * @elem.data: Data for multiple BSSID elements. 1260 * @elem.len: Length of data. 1261 */ 1262 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems { 1263 u8 cnt; 1264 struct { 1265 const u8 *data; 1266 size_t len; 1267 } elem[] __counted_by(cnt); 1268 }; 1269 1270 /** 1271 * struct cfg80211_rnr_elems - Reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements 1272 * 1273 * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems. 1274 * 1275 * @elem: Array of RNR element(s) to be added into Beacon frames. 1276 * @elem.data: Data for RNR elements. 1277 * @elem.len: Length of data. 1278 */ 1279 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems { 1280 u8 cnt; 1281 struct { 1282 const u8 *data; 1283 size_t len; 1284 } elem[] __counted_by(cnt); 1285 }; 1286 1287 /** 1288 * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data 1289 * @link_id: the link ID for the AP MLD link sending this beacon 1290 * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE) 1291 * or %NULL if not changed 1292 * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE) 1293 * or %NULL if not changed 1294 * @head_len: length of @head 1295 * @tail_len: length of @tail 1296 * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL 1297 * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets 1298 * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response 1299 * frames or %NULL 1300 * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets 1301 * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association 1302 * Response frames or %NULL 1303 * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets 1304 * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp) 1305 * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only) 1306 * @mbssid_ies: multiple BSSID elements 1307 * @rnr_ies: reduced neighbor report elements 1308 * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change 1309 * (which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data) 1310 * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token 1311 * (measurement type 8) 1312 * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement 1313 * Token (measurement type 11) 1314 * @lci_len: LCI data length 1315 * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length 1316 * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings 1317 * @he_bss_color_valid: indicates whether bss color 1318 * attribute is present in beacon data or not. 1319 */ 1320 struct cfg80211_beacon_data { 1321 unsigned int link_id; 1322 1323 const u8 *head, *tail; 1324 const u8 *beacon_ies; 1325 const u8 *proberesp_ies; 1326 const u8 *assocresp_ies; 1327 const u8 *probe_resp; 1328 const u8 *lci; 1329 const u8 *civicloc; 1330 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems *mbssid_ies; 1331 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems *rnr_ies; 1332 s8 ftm_responder; 1333 1334 size_t head_len, tail_len; 1335 size_t beacon_ies_len; 1336 size_t proberesp_ies_len; 1337 size_t assocresp_ies_len; 1338 size_t probe_resp_len; 1339 size_t lci_len; 1340 size_t civicloc_len; 1341 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color; 1342 bool he_bss_color_valid; 1343 }; 1344 1345 struct mac_address { 1346 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 1347 }; 1348 1349 /** 1350 * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data 1351 * 1352 * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's 1353 * entry specified by mac_addr 1354 * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed 1355 * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL 1356 */ 1357 struct cfg80211_acl_data { 1358 enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy; 1359 int n_acl_entries; 1360 1361 /* Keep it last */ 1362 struct mac_address mac_addrs[] __counted_by(n_acl_entries); 1363 }; 1364 1365 /** 1366 * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from 1367 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 1368 * 1369 * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated. 1370 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1371 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1372 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1373 * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action 1374 * frame headers. 1375 */ 1376 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery { 1377 bool update; 1378 u32 min_interval; 1379 u32 max_interval; 1380 size_t tmpl_len; 1381 const u8 *tmpl; 1382 }; 1383 1384 /** 1385 * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe 1386 * response parameters in 6GHz. 1387 * 1388 * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated. 1389 * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned 1390 * in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive 1391 * scanning 1392 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1393 * @tmpl: Template data for probe response 1394 */ 1395 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp { 1396 bool update; 1397 u32 interval; 1398 size_t tmpl_len; 1399 const u8 *tmpl; 1400 }; 1401 1402 /** 1403 * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration 1404 * 1405 * Used to configure an AP interface. 1406 * 1407 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 1408 * @beacon: beacon data 1409 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1410 * @dtim_period: DTIM period 1411 * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from 1412 * user space) 1413 * @ssid_len: length of @ssid 1414 * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames 1415 * @crypto: crypto settings 1416 * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy 1417 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 1418 * @smps_mode: SMPS mode 1419 * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity. 1420 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window 1421 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS 1422 * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for 1423 * MAC address based access control 1424 * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG 1425 * networks. 1426 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 1427 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled) 1428 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled) 1429 * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1430 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled) 1431 * @eht_oper: EHT operation IE (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled) 1432 * @ht_required: stations must support HT 1433 * @vht_required: stations must support VHT 1434 * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time 1435 * @he_required: stations must support HE 1436 * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE 1437 * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags 1438 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings 1439 * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1440 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters 1441 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters 1442 * @mbssid_config: AP settings for multiple bssid 1443 * @punct_bitmap: Preamble puncturing bitmap. Each bit represents 1444 * a 20 MHz channel, lowest bit corresponding to the lowest channel. 1445 * Bit set to 1 indicates that the channel is punctured. 1446 */ 1447 struct cfg80211_ap_settings { 1448 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1449 1450 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon; 1451 1452 int beacon_interval, dtim_period; 1453 const u8 *ssid; 1454 size_t ssid_len; 1455 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid; 1456 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 1457 bool privacy; 1458 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 1459 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 1460 int inactivity_timeout; 1461 u8 p2p_ctwindow; 1462 bool p2p_opp_ps; 1463 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl; 1464 bool pbss; 1465 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 1466 1467 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap; 1468 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap; 1469 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap; 1470 const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper; 1471 const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_cap; 1472 const struct ieee80211_eht_operation *eht_oper; 1473 bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required; 1474 bool twt_responder; 1475 u32 flags; 1476 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd; 1477 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 1478 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp; 1479 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config mbssid_config; 1480 u16 punct_bitmap; 1481 }; 1482 1483 1484 /** 1485 * struct cfg80211_ap_update - AP configuration update 1486 * 1487 * Subset of &struct cfg80211_ap_settings, for updating a running AP. 1488 * 1489 * @beacon: beacon data 1490 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters 1491 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters 1492 */ 1493 struct cfg80211_ap_update { 1494 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon; 1495 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 1496 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp; 1497 }; 1498 1499 /** 1500 * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings 1501 * 1502 * Used for channel switch 1503 * 1504 * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch 1505 * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch 1506 * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail) 1507 * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response 1508 * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail) 1509 * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response 1510 * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel 1511 * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel 1512 * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing 1513 * @count: number of beacons until switch 1514 * @punct_bitmap: Preamble puncturing bitmap. Each bit represents 1515 * a 20 MHz channel, lowest bit corresponding to the lowest channel. 1516 * Bit set to 1 indicates that the channel is punctured. 1517 */ 1518 struct cfg80211_csa_settings { 1519 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1520 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa; 1521 const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon; 1522 const u16 *counter_offsets_presp; 1523 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon; 1524 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp; 1525 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after; 1526 bool radar_required; 1527 bool block_tx; 1528 u8 count; 1529 u16 punct_bitmap; 1530 }; 1531 1532 /** 1533 * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings 1534 * 1535 * Used for bss color change 1536 * 1537 * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown 1538 * @counter_offset_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail) 1539 * @counter_offset_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response 1540 * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change 1541 * @count: number of beacons until the color change 1542 * @color: the color used after the change 1543 */ 1544 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings { 1545 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change; 1546 u16 counter_offset_beacon; 1547 u16 counter_offset_presp; 1548 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next; 1549 u8 count; 1550 u8 color; 1551 }; 1552 1553 /** 1554 * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations 1555 * 1556 * Used to pass interface combination parameters 1557 * 1558 * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want 1559 * to use for verification 1560 * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel 1561 * width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of 1562 * &struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths 1563 * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface 1564 * type. The index is the interface type as specified in &enum 1565 * nl80211_iftype. 1566 * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface 1567 * that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of 1568 * the verification 1569 */ 1570 struct iface_combination_params { 1571 int num_different_channels; 1572 u8 radar_detect; 1573 int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES]; 1574 u32 new_beacon_int; 1575 }; 1576 1577 /** 1578 * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply 1579 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp) 1580 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability 1581 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state 1582 * 1583 * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling, 1584 * for those that don't these flags will are used. 1585 */ 1586 enum station_parameters_apply_mask { 1587 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0), 1588 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1), 1589 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2), 1590 }; 1591 1592 /** 1593 * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration 1594 * 1595 * Used to configure txpower for station. 1596 * 1597 * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power 1598 * is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be 1599 * overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx 1600 * power per-interface or per-station. 1601 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power 1602 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC 1603 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power. 1604 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for 1605 * per peer TPC. 1606 */ 1607 struct sta_txpwr { 1608 s16 power; 1609 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type; 1610 }; 1611 1612 /** 1613 * struct link_station_parameters - link station parameters 1614 * 1615 * Used to change and create a new link station. 1616 * 1617 * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station 1618 * @link_id: the link id (-1 for non-MLD station) 1619 * @link_mac: MAC address of the link 1620 * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format 1621 * (or NULL for no change) 1622 * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates 1623 * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station 1624 * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station 1625 * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification 1626 * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used 1627 * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station 1628 * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities 1629 * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station 1630 * @txpwr_set: txpwr field is set 1631 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station 1632 * @eht_capa: EHT capabilities of station 1633 * @eht_capa_len: the length of the EHT capabilities 1634 */ 1635 struct link_station_parameters { 1636 const u8 *mld_mac; 1637 int link_id; 1638 const u8 *link_mac; 1639 const u8 *supported_rates; 1640 u8 supported_rates_len; 1641 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa; 1642 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa; 1643 u8 opmode_notif; 1644 bool opmode_notif_used; 1645 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa; 1646 u8 he_capa_len; 1647 struct sta_txpwr txpwr; 1648 bool txpwr_set; 1649 const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa; 1650 const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_capa; 1651 u8 eht_capa_len; 1652 }; 1653 1654 /** 1655 * struct link_station_del_parameters - link station deletion parameters 1656 * 1657 * Used to delete a link station entry (or all stations). 1658 * 1659 * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station 1660 * @link_id: the link id 1661 */ 1662 struct link_station_del_parameters { 1663 const u8 *mld_mac; 1664 u32 link_id; 1665 }; 1666 1667 /** 1668 * struct station_parameters - station parameters 1669 * 1670 * Used to change and create a new station. 1671 * 1672 * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to 1673 * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed 1674 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1675 * @sta_flags_set: station flags values 1676 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1677 * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change 1678 * @aid: AID or zero for no change 1679 * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero) 1680 * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change 1681 * @plink_action: plink action to take 1682 * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station 1683 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format 1684 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 1685 * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the 1686 * QoS info field (but already shifted down) 1687 * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed 1688 * (for those that don't have a natural "no change" value), 1689 * see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask 1690 * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set 1691 * to unknown) 1692 * @capability: station capability 1693 * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station 1694 * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities 1695 * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format 1696 * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels 1697 * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format 1698 * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes 1699 * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism 1700 * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station 1701 * @link_sta_params: link related params. 1702 */ 1703 struct station_parameters { 1704 struct net_device *vlan; 1705 u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set; 1706 u32 sta_modify_mask; 1707 int listen_interval; 1708 u16 aid; 1709 u16 vlan_id; 1710 u16 peer_aid; 1711 u8 plink_action; 1712 u8 plink_state; 1713 u8 uapsd_queues; 1714 u8 max_sp; 1715 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 1716 u16 capability; 1717 const u8 *ext_capab; 1718 u8 ext_capab_len; 1719 const u8 *supported_channels; 1720 u8 supported_channels_len; 1721 const u8 *supported_oper_classes; 1722 u8 supported_oper_classes_len; 1723 int support_p2p_ps; 1724 u16 airtime_weight; 1725 struct link_station_parameters link_sta_params; 1726 }; 1727 1728 /** 1729 * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters 1730 * 1731 * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations). 1732 * 1733 * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations 1734 * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal 1735 * (10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication) 1736 * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame 1737 */ 1738 struct station_del_parameters { 1739 const u8 *mac; 1740 u8 subtype; 1741 u16 reason_code; 1742 }; 1743 1744 /** 1745 * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified 1746 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface 1747 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still 1748 * unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted) 1749 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has 1750 * the AP MLME in the device 1751 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface 1752 * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station 1753 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry 1754 * while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when 1755 * being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is 1756 * supported/used) 1757 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active 1758 * entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace) 1759 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed) 1760 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed) 1761 */ 1762 enum cfg80211_station_type { 1763 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT, 1764 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC, 1765 CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT, 1766 CFG80211_STA_AP_STA, 1767 CFG80211_STA_IBSS, 1768 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP, 1769 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE, 1770 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL, 1771 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER, 1772 }; 1773 1774 /** 1775 * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes 1776 * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on 1777 * @params: the new parameters for a station 1778 * @statype: the type of station being modified 1779 * 1780 * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function 1781 * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that 1782 * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if 1783 * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for 1784 * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this. 1785 */ 1786 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1787 struct station_parameters *params, 1788 enum cfg80211_station_type statype); 1789 1790 /** 1791 * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags 1792 * 1793 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1794 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1795 * 1796 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS 1797 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS 1798 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval 1799 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS 1800 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information 1801 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode 1802 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS 1803 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS information 1804 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS: MCS field filled with S1G MCS 1805 */ 1806 enum rate_info_flags { 1807 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS = BIT(0), 1808 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS = BIT(1), 1809 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI = BIT(2), 1810 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG = BIT(3), 1811 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS = BIT(4), 1812 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG = BIT(5), 1813 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG = BIT(6), 1814 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS = BIT(7), 1815 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS = BIT(8), 1816 }; 1817 1818 /** 1819 * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information 1820 * 1821 * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth. 1822 * 1823 * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth 1824 * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth 1825 * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth 1826 * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth 1827 * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth 1828 * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth 1829 * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation 1830 * @RATE_INFO_BW_320: 320 MHz bandwidth 1831 * @RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU: bandwidth determined by EHT RU allocation 1832 * @RATE_INFO_BW_1: 1 MHz bandwidth 1833 * @RATE_INFO_BW_2: 2 MHz bandwidth 1834 * @RATE_INFO_BW_4: 4 MHz bandwidth 1835 * @RATE_INFO_BW_8: 8 MHz bandwidth 1836 * @RATE_INFO_BW_16: 16 MHz bandwidth 1837 */ 1838 enum rate_info_bw { 1839 RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0, 1840 RATE_INFO_BW_5, 1841 RATE_INFO_BW_10, 1842 RATE_INFO_BW_40, 1843 RATE_INFO_BW_80, 1844 RATE_INFO_BW_160, 1845 RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU, 1846 RATE_INFO_BW_320, 1847 RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU, 1848 RATE_INFO_BW_1, 1849 RATE_INFO_BW_2, 1850 RATE_INFO_BW_4, 1851 RATE_INFO_BW_8, 1852 RATE_INFO_BW_16, 1853 }; 1854 1855 /** 1856 * struct rate_info - bitrate information 1857 * 1858 * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate 1859 * 1860 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags 1861 * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg 1862 * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE/EHT/S1G rate 1863 * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only) 1864 * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw) 1865 * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi) 1866 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value 1867 * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc, 1868 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU) 1869 * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4) 1870 * @eht_gi: EHT guard interval (from &enum nl80211_eht_gi) 1871 * @eht_ru_alloc: EHT RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc, 1872 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU) 1873 */ 1874 struct rate_info { 1875 u16 flags; 1876 u16 legacy; 1877 u8 mcs; 1878 u8 nss; 1879 u8 bw; 1880 u8 he_gi; 1881 u8 he_dcm; 1882 u8 he_ru_alloc; 1883 u8 n_bonded_ch; 1884 u8 eht_gi; 1885 u8 eht_ru_alloc; 1886 }; 1887 1888 /** 1889 * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags 1890 * 1891 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1892 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1893 * 1894 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled 1895 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled 1896 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled 1897 */ 1898 enum bss_param_flags { 1899 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT = 1<<0, 1900 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<1, 1901 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME = 1<<2, 1902 }; 1903 1904 /** 1905 * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station 1906 * 1907 * Information about the currently associated BSS 1908 * 1909 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags 1910 * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS 1911 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1912 */ 1913 struct sta_bss_parameters { 1914 u8 flags; 1915 u8 dtim_period; 1916 u16 beacon_interval; 1917 }; 1918 1919 /** 1920 * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID 1921 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to 1922 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 1923 * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged 1924 * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged 1925 * @flows: number of new flows seen 1926 * @drops: total number of packets dropped 1927 * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE 1928 * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow 1929 * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow 1930 * @collisions: number of hash collisions 1931 * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued 1932 * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued 1933 * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported 1934 */ 1935 struct cfg80211_txq_stats { 1936 u32 filled; 1937 u32 backlog_bytes; 1938 u32 backlog_packets; 1939 u32 flows; 1940 u32 drops; 1941 u32 ecn_marks; 1942 u32 overlimit; 1943 u32 overmemory; 1944 u32 collisions; 1945 u32 tx_bytes; 1946 u32 tx_packets; 1947 u32 max_flows; 1948 }; 1949 1950 /** 1951 * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics 1952 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to 1953 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 1954 * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs 1955 * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs 1956 * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for 1957 * transmitted MSDUs 1958 * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs 1959 * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics 1960 */ 1961 struct cfg80211_tid_stats { 1962 u32 filled; 1963 u64 rx_msdu; 1964 u64 tx_msdu; 1965 u64 tx_msdu_retries; 1966 u64 tx_msdu_failed; 1967 struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats; 1968 }; 1969 1970 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS 4 1971 1972 /** 1973 * struct station_info - station information 1974 * 1975 * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station. 1976 * 1977 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to 1978 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 1979 * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected 1980 * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds 1981 * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association 1982 * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station 1983 * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station 1984 * @llid: mesh local link id 1985 * @plid: mesh peer link id 1986 * @plink_state: mesh peer link state 1987 * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 1988 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 1989 * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 1990 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 1991 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg 1992 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm 1993 * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm 1994 * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station 1995 * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station 1996 * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station 1997 * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station 1998 * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs) 1999 * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK) 2000 * @rx_dropped_misc: Dropped for un-specified reason. 2001 * @bss_param: current BSS parameters 2002 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 2003 * This number should increase every time the list of stations 2004 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 2005 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 2006 * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request. 2007 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use 2008 * user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for 2009 * the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. 2010 * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets. 2011 * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values 2012 * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered. 2013 * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host. 2014 * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode 2015 * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode 2016 * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode 2017 * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers) 2018 * towards this station. 2019 * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer 2020 * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received 2021 * from this peer 2022 * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate 2023 * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer 2024 * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer 2025 * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight 2026 * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last 2027 * (IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs. 2028 * Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL. 2029 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame. 2030 * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has 2031 * been sent. 2032 * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station 2033 * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with 2034 * an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the 2035 * received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address. 2036 * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric. 2037 * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server 2038 * @mlo_params_valid: Indicates @assoc_link_id and @mld_addr fields are filled 2039 * by driver. Drivers use this only in cfg80211_new_sta() calls when AP 2040 * MLD's MLME/SME is offload to driver. Drivers won't fill this 2041 * information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and 2042 * dump_station() callbacks. 2043 * @assoc_link_id: Indicates MLO link ID of the AP, with which the station 2044 * completed (re)association. This information filled for both MLO 2045 * and non-MLO STA connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. 2046 * @mld_addr: For MLO STA connection, filled with MLD address of the station. 2047 * For non-MLO STA connection, filled with all zeros. 2048 * @assoc_resp_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Response. 2049 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use user 2050 * space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided only for the 2051 * cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. Drivers won't 2052 * fill this information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and 2053 * dump_station() callbacks. User space needs this information to determine 2054 * the accepted and rejected affiliated links of the connected station. 2055 * @assoc_resp_ies_len: Length of @assoc_resp_ies buffer in octets. 2056 */ 2057 struct station_info { 2058 u64 filled; 2059 u32 connected_time; 2060 u32 inactive_time; 2061 u64 assoc_at; 2062 u64 rx_bytes; 2063 u64 tx_bytes; 2064 u16 llid; 2065 u16 plid; 2066 u8 plink_state; 2067 s8 signal; 2068 s8 signal_avg; 2069 2070 u8 chains; 2071 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2072 s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2073 2074 struct rate_info txrate; 2075 struct rate_info rxrate; 2076 u32 rx_packets; 2077 u32 tx_packets; 2078 u32 tx_retries; 2079 u32 tx_failed; 2080 u32 rx_dropped_misc; 2081 struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param; 2082 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags; 2083 2084 int generation; 2085 2086 const u8 *assoc_req_ies; 2087 size_t assoc_req_ies_len; 2088 2089 u32 beacon_loss_count; 2090 s64 t_offset; 2091 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 2092 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm; 2093 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm; 2094 2095 u32 expected_throughput; 2096 2097 u64 tx_duration; 2098 u64 rx_duration; 2099 u64 rx_beacon; 2100 u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg; 2101 u8 connected_to_gate; 2102 2103 struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid; 2104 s8 ack_signal; 2105 s8 avg_ack_signal; 2106 2107 u16 airtime_weight; 2108 2109 u32 rx_mpdu_count; 2110 u32 fcs_err_count; 2111 2112 u32 airtime_link_metric; 2113 2114 u8 connected_to_as; 2115 2116 bool mlo_params_valid; 2117 u8 assoc_link_id; 2118 u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2119 const u8 *assoc_resp_ies; 2120 size_t assoc_resp_ies_len; 2121 }; 2122 2123 /** 2124 * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit 2125 * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm 2126 * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to 2127 */ 2128 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs { 2129 s32 power; 2130 u32 freq_range_index; 2131 }; 2132 2133 /** 2134 * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs 2135 * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types 2136 * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs 2137 * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs 2138 */ 2139 struct cfg80211_sar_specs { 2140 enum nl80211_sar_type type; 2141 u32 num_sub_specs; 2142 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[]; 2143 }; 2144 2145 2146 /** 2147 * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges 2148 * @start_freq: start range edge frequency 2149 * @end_freq: end range edge frequency 2150 */ 2151 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges { 2152 u32 start_freq; 2153 u32 end_freq; 2154 }; 2155 2156 /** 2157 * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability 2158 * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types 2159 * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges 2160 * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges. 2161 * 2162 * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing 2163 * range to small ones and then append them. 2164 */ 2165 struct cfg80211_sar_capa { 2166 enum nl80211_sar_type type; 2167 u32 num_freq_ranges; 2168 const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges; 2169 }; 2170 2171 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211) 2172 /** 2173 * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station 2174 * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to 2175 * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest 2176 * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information 2177 * 2178 * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information 2179 * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be 2180 * considered undefined. 2181 */ 2182 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 2183 struct station_info *sinfo); 2184 #else 2185 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, 2186 const u8 *mac_addr, 2187 struct station_info *sinfo) 2188 { 2189 return -ENOENT; 2190 } 2191 #endif 2192 2193 /** 2194 * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags 2195 * 2196 * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits 2197 * according to the nl80211 flags. 2198 * 2199 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed 2200 * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS 2201 * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP 2202 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames 2203 * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering 2204 * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing 2205 * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address 2206 */ 2207 enum monitor_flags { 2208 MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED = 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID, 2209 MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL, 2210 MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL, 2211 MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL, 2212 MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS, 2213 MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES, 2214 MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE, 2215 }; 2216 2217 /** 2218 * enum mpath_info_flags - mesh path information flags 2219 * 2220 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled 2221 * in during get_station() or dump_station(). 2222 * 2223 * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled 2224 * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled 2225 * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled 2226 * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled 2227 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled 2228 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled 2229 * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled 2230 * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled 2231 * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled 2232 */ 2233 enum mpath_info_flags { 2234 MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN = BIT(0), 2235 MPATH_INFO_SN = BIT(1), 2236 MPATH_INFO_METRIC = BIT(2), 2237 MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME = BIT(3), 2238 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT = BIT(4), 2239 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES = BIT(5), 2240 MPATH_INFO_FLAGS = BIT(6), 2241 MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT = BIT(7), 2242 MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE = BIT(8), 2243 }; 2244 2245 /** 2246 * struct mpath_info - mesh path information 2247 * 2248 * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath(). 2249 * 2250 * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags 2251 * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination 2252 * @sn: target sequence number 2253 * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path 2254 * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs 2255 * @flags: mesh path flags from &enum mesh_path_flags 2256 * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs 2257 * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries 2258 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 2259 * This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths 2260 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 2261 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 2262 * @hop_count: hops to destination 2263 * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination 2264 */ 2265 struct mpath_info { 2266 u32 filled; 2267 u32 frame_qlen; 2268 u32 sn; 2269 u32 metric; 2270 u32 exptime; 2271 u32 discovery_timeout; 2272 u8 discovery_retries; 2273 u8 flags; 2274 u8 hop_count; 2275 u32 path_change_count; 2276 2277 int generation; 2278 }; 2279 2280 /** 2281 * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters 2282 * 2283 * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode). 2284 * 2285 * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD 2286 * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection 2287 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 2288 * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed 2289 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 2290 * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed 2291 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 2292 * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format 2293 * (or NULL for no change) 2294 * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates 2295 * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations 2296 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 2297 * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode 2298 * (u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change) 2299 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change) 2300 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change) 2301 */ 2302 struct bss_parameters { 2303 int link_id; 2304 int use_cts_prot; 2305 int use_short_preamble; 2306 int use_short_slot_time; 2307 const u8 *basic_rates; 2308 u8 basic_rates_len; 2309 int ap_isolate; 2310 int ht_opmode; 2311 s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps; 2312 }; 2313 2314 /** 2315 * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration 2316 * 2317 * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active. 2318 * 2319 * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used 2320 * by the Mesh Peering Open message 2321 * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units 2322 * used by the Mesh Peering Open message 2323 * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by 2324 * the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering 2325 * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this 2326 * mesh interface 2327 * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can 2328 * be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh 2329 * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA 2330 * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection 2331 * elements 2332 * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we 2333 * detect compatible mesh peers 2334 * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to 2335 * synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method 2336 * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ 2337 * that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target 2338 * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds 2339 * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on 2340 * a path discovery in milliseconds 2341 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 2342 * receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the 2343 * root to be valid. (TU = time unit) 2344 * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 2345 * which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ 2346 * element 2347 * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 2348 * which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR 2349 * element 2350 * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that 2351 * it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh 2352 * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA 2353 * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root 2354 * announcements are transmitted 2355 * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh 2356 * station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is 2357 * missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true 2358 * only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but 2359 * not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the 2360 * same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec) 2361 * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding 2362 * entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity) 2363 * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate 2364 * station to establish a peer link 2365 * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode 2366 * 2367 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 2368 * receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to 2369 * the root mesh STA to be valid. 2370 * 2371 * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive 2372 * PREQs are transmitted. 2373 * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs) 2374 * during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing 2375 * a PREQ element for root path confirmation. 2376 * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial 2377 * setting for new peer links. 2378 * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake 2379 * after transmitting its beacon. 2380 * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established 2381 * peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it 2382 * from the STA's list of peers. Default is 30 minutes. 2383 * @dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer: if set to true then this mesh STA 2384 * will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server 2385 * in the mesh formation field. 2386 * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is 2387 * connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info. If false, the 2388 * value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths 2389 * in the mesh path table 2390 * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP 2391 * for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might 2392 * not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So 2393 * if using this setting you will likely also want to disable 2394 * dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top. 2395 */ 2396 struct mesh_config { 2397 u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout; 2398 u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout; 2399 u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout; 2400 u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks; 2401 u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries; 2402 u8 dot11MeshTTL; 2403 u8 element_ttl; 2404 bool auto_open_plinks; 2405 u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor; 2406 u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries; 2407 u32 path_refresh_time; 2408 u16 min_discovery_timeout; 2409 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout; 2410 u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval; 2411 u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval; 2412 u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime; 2413 u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode; 2414 bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate; 2415 bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer; 2416 u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval; 2417 bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol; 2418 bool dot11MeshForwarding; 2419 s32 rssi_threshold; 2420 u16 ht_opmode; 2421 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout; 2422 u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval; 2423 u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval; 2424 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode; 2425 u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration; 2426 u32 plink_timeout; 2427 bool dot11MeshNolearn; 2428 }; 2429 2430 /** 2431 * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration 2432 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 2433 * @mesh_id: the mesh ID 2434 * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes 2435 * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use 2436 * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use 2437 * @path_metric: which metric to use 2438 * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using 2439 * @ie: vendor information elements (optional) 2440 * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements 2441 * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication 2442 * @is_secure: this mesh uses security 2443 * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions 2444 * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use 2445 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 2446 * @mcast_rate: multicast rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a] 2447 * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh 2448 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 2449 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 2450 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 2451 * to operate on DFS channels. 2452 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 2453 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 2454 * 2455 * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created. 2456 */ 2457 struct mesh_setup { 2458 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2459 const u8 *mesh_id; 2460 u8 mesh_id_len; 2461 u8 sync_method; 2462 u8 path_sel_proto; 2463 u8 path_metric; 2464 u8 auth_id; 2465 const u8 *ie; 2466 u8 ie_len; 2467 bool is_authenticated; 2468 bool is_secure; 2469 bool user_mpm; 2470 u8 dtim_period; 2471 u16 beacon_interval; 2472 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2473 u32 basic_rates; 2474 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 2475 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 2476 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 2477 }; 2478 2479 /** 2480 * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration 2481 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 2482 * 2483 * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network 2484 */ 2485 struct ocb_setup { 2486 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2487 }; 2488 2489 /** 2490 * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters 2491 * @ac: AC identifier 2492 * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled 2493 * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2494 * 1..32767] 2495 * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2496 * 1..32767] 2497 * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255] 2498 * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD 2499 */ 2500 struct ieee80211_txq_params { 2501 enum nl80211_ac ac; 2502 u16 txop; 2503 u16 cwmin; 2504 u16 cwmax; 2505 u8 aifs; 2506 int link_id; 2507 }; 2508 2509 /** 2510 * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling 2511 * 2512 * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite 2513 * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will 2514 * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the 2515 * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the 2516 * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to 2517 * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements 2518 * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be 2519 * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised 2520 * in the wiphy structure. 2521 * 2522 * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because 2523 * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not 2524 * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist. 2525 * 2526 * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of 2527 * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the 2528 * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available 2529 * to userspace. 2530 */ 2531 2532 /** 2533 * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description 2534 * @ssid: the SSID 2535 * @ssid_len: length of the ssid 2536 */ 2537 struct cfg80211_ssid { 2538 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 2539 u8 ssid_len; 2540 }; 2541 2542 /** 2543 * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan 2544 * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the 2545 * wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this 2546 * information is not available, this field is left zero. 2547 * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set. 2548 * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason, 2549 * userspace will be notified of that 2550 */ 2551 struct cfg80211_scan_info { 2552 u64 scan_start_tsf; 2553 u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2554 bool aborted; 2555 }; 2556 2557 /** 2558 * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only 2559 * 2560 * @short_ssid: short ssid to scan for 2561 * @bssid: bssid to scan for 2562 * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request 2563 * which the above info relvant to 2564 * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU 2565 * @short_ssid_valid: @short_ssid is valid and can be used 2566 * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait 2567 * 20 TUs before starting to send probe requests. 2568 * @psd_20: The AP's 20 MHz PSD value. 2569 */ 2570 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params { 2571 u32 short_ssid; 2572 u32 channel_idx; 2573 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2574 bool unsolicited_probe; 2575 bool short_ssid_valid; 2576 bool psc_no_listen; 2577 s8 psd_20; 2578 }; 2579 2580 /** 2581 * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description 2582 * 2583 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only) 2584 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2585 * @channels: channels to scan on. 2586 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2587 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2588 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2589 * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If 2590 * %duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and 2591 * the actual dwell time may be shorter. 2592 * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the 2593 * %duration field. 2594 * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags 2595 * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band 2596 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2597 * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started 2598 * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for 2599 * @info: (internal) information about completed scan 2600 * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted 2601 * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band 2602 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2603 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2604 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2605 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2606 * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only, 2607 * true if this is the second scan request 2608 * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params 2609 * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params 2610 * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID) 2611 * @tsf_report_link_id: for MLO, indicates the link ID of the BSS that should be 2612 * used for TSF reporting. Can be set to -1 to indicate no preference. 2613 */ 2614 struct cfg80211_scan_request { 2615 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2616 int n_ssids; 2617 u32 n_channels; 2618 const u8 *ie; 2619 size_t ie_len; 2620 u16 duration; 2621 bool duration_mandatory; 2622 u32 flags; 2623 2624 u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2625 2626 struct wireless_dev *wdev; 2627 2628 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2629 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2630 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2631 2632 /* internal */ 2633 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2634 unsigned long scan_start; 2635 struct cfg80211_scan_info info; 2636 bool notified; 2637 bool no_cck; 2638 bool scan_6ghz; 2639 u32 n_6ghz_params; 2640 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params; 2641 s8 tsf_report_link_id; 2642 2643 /* keep last */ 2644 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels); 2645 }; 2646 2647 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask) 2648 { 2649 int i; 2650 2651 get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN); 2652 for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) { 2653 buf[i] &= ~mask[i]; 2654 buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i]; 2655 } 2656 } 2657 2658 /** 2659 * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match 2660 * 2661 * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match 2662 * or no match (RSSI only) 2663 * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match 2664 * or no match (RSSI only) 2665 * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm) 2666 * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied 2667 * for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertise this support 2668 * of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability 2669 * %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band 2670 * specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified. 2671 * If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of 2672 * corresponding matchset. 2673 */ 2674 struct cfg80211_match_set { 2675 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 2676 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2677 s32 rssi_thold; 2678 s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2679 }; 2680 2681 /** 2682 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan 2683 * 2684 * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds. 2685 * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means 2686 * infinite loop. 2687 * The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero, 2688 * all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations. 2689 */ 2690 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan { 2691 u32 interval; 2692 u32 iterations; 2693 }; 2694 2695 /** 2696 * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment. 2697 * 2698 * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment. 2699 * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment. 2700 */ 2701 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust { 2702 enum nl80211_band band; 2703 s8 delta; 2704 }; 2705 2706 /** 2707 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description 2708 * 2709 * @reqid: identifies this request. 2710 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans) 2711 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2712 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2713 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2714 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2715 * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags 2716 * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result 2717 * entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host 2718 * (others are filtered out). 2719 * If omitted, all results are passed. 2720 * @n_match_sets: number of match sets 2721 * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request 2722 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2723 * @dev: the interface 2724 * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan 2725 * @channels: channels to scan 2726 * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this 2727 * contains the minimum over all matchsets 2728 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2729 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2730 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2731 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2732 * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest 2733 * index must be executed first. 2734 * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1. 2735 * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct 2736 * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request 2737 * owned by a particular socket) 2738 * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed 2739 * @list: for keeping list of requests. 2740 * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan 2741 * cycle. The driver may ignore this parameter and start 2742 * immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not 2743 * supported. 2744 * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not. 2745 * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result 2746 * reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined 2747 * to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS. 2748 * The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state. 2749 * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong 2750 * to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported 2751 * using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that 2752 * belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative 2753 * comparisons. 2754 */ 2755 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request { 2756 u64 reqid; 2757 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2758 int n_ssids; 2759 u32 n_channels; 2760 const u8 *ie; 2761 size_t ie_len; 2762 u32 flags; 2763 struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets; 2764 int n_match_sets; 2765 s32 min_rssi_thold; 2766 u32 delay; 2767 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans; 2768 int n_scan_plans; 2769 2770 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2771 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2772 2773 bool relative_rssi_set; 2774 s8 relative_rssi; 2775 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust; 2776 2777 /* internal */ 2778 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2779 struct net_device *dev; 2780 unsigned long scan_start; 2781 bool report_results; 2782 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2783 u32 owner_nlportid; 2784 bool nl_owner_dead; 2785 struct list_head list; 2786 2787 /* keep last */ 2788 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[]; 2789 }; 2790 2791 /** 2792 * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type 2793 * 2794 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available 2795 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm) 2796 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100 2797 */ 2798 enum cfg80211_signal_type { 2799 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE, 2800 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, 2801 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC, 2802 }; 2803 2804 /** 2805 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data 2806 * @chan: channel the frame was received on 2807 * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's 2808 * signal type 2809 * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was 2810 * received; should match the time when the frame was actually 2811 * received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was 2812 * buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms. 2813 * If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of 2814 * ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate. 2815 * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the 2816 * timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified 2817 * by %parent_bssid. 2818 * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to 2819 * the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received. 2820 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2821 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2822 * @drv_data: Data to be passed through to @inform_bss 2823 */ 2824 struct cfg80211_inform_bss { 2825 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 2826 s32 signal; 2827 u64 boottime_ns; 2828 u64 parent_tsf; 2829 u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2830 u8 chains; 2831 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2832 2833 void *drv_data; 2834 }; 2835 2836 /** 2837 * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data 2838 * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs 2839 * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing 2840 * @len: length of the IEs 2841 * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon 2842 * @data: IE data 2843 */ 2844 struct cfg80211_bss_ies { 2845 u64 tsf; 2846 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2847 int len; 2848 bool from_beacon; 2849 u8 data[]; 2850 }; 2851 2852 /** 2853 * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description 2854 * 2855 * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network) 2856 * for use in scan results and similar. 2857 * 2858 * @channel: channel this BSS is on 2859 * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS 2860 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame 2861 * @capability: the capability field in host byte order 2862 * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these 2863 * are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or 2864 * proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been 2865 * received. It is always non-%NULL. 2866 * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame 2867 * (implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't 2868 * own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the 2869 * @hidden_beacon_bss struct) 2870 * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame 2871 * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from 2872 * a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct 2873 * that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and 2874 * points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case. 2875 * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a 2876 * non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support) 2877 * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one 2878 * (multi-BSSID support) 2879 * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type) 2880 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2881 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2882 * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set 2883 * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set 2884 * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes 2885 */ 2886 struct cfg80211_bss { 2887 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 2888 2889 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies; 2890 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies; 2891 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies; 2892 2893 struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss; 2894 struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss; 2895 struct list_head nontrans_list; 2896 2897 s32 signal; 2898 2899 u16 beacon_interval; 2900 u16 capability; 2901 2902 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2903 u8 chains; 2904 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2905 2906 u8 bssid_index; 2907 u8 max_bssid_indicator; 2908 2909 u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2910 }; 2911 2912 /** 2913 * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID 2914 * @bss: the bss to search 2915 * @id: the element ID 2916 * 2917 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 2918 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 2919 * Return: %NULL if not found. 2920 */ 2921 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id); 2922 2923 /** 2924 * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID 2925 * @bss: the bss to search 2926 * @id: the element ID 2927 * 2928 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 2929 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 2930 * Return: %NULL if not found. 2931 */ 2932 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id) 2933 { 2934 return (const void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id); 2935 } 2936 2937 2938 /** 2939 * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data 2940 * 2941 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2942 * authentication. 2943 * 2944 * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference 2945 * to it if it needs to keep it. 2946 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 2947 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL 2948 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2949 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 2950 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 2951 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 2952 * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains 2953 * the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the 2954 * Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication 2955 * transaction sequence number field. 2956 * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets 2957 * @link_id: if >= 0, indicates authentication should be done as an MLD, 2958 * the interface address is included as the MLD address and the 2959 * necessary link (with the given link_id) will be created (and 2960 * given an MLD address) by the driver 2961 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of authentication request with 2962 * an AP MLD, valid iff @link_id >= 0 2963 */ 2964 struct cfg80211_auth_request { 2965 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2966 const u8 *ie; 2967 size_t ie_len; 2968 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 2969 const u8 *key; 2970 u8 key_len; 2971 s8 key_idx; 2972 const u8 *auth_data; 2973 size_t auth_data_len; 2974 s8 link_id; 2975 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 2976 }; 2977 2978 /** 2979 * struct cfg80211_assoc_link - per-link information for MLO association 2980 * @bss: the BSS pointer, see also &struct cfg80211_assoc_request::bss; 2981 * if this is %NULL for a link, that link is not requested 2982 * @elems: extra elements for the per-STA profile for this link 2983 * @elems_len: length of the elements 2984 * @disabled: If set this link should be included during association etc. but it 2985 * should not be used until enabled by the AP MLD. 2986 * @error: per-link error code, must be <= 0. If there is an error, then the 2987 * operation as a whole must fail. 2988 */ 2989 struct cfg80211_assoc_link { 2990 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2991 const u8 *elems; 2992 size_t elems_len; 2993 bool disabled; 2994 int error; 2995 }; 2996 2997 /** 2998 * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association. 2999 * 3000 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT: Disable HT (802.11n) 3001 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT: Disable VHT 3002 * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association 3003 * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external 3004 * authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to 3005 * userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect() 3006 * request (connect callback). 3007 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE: Disable HE 3008 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT: Disable EHT 3009 * @CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT: Userspace indicates support for handling MLD links. 3010 * Drivers shall disable MLO features for the current association if this 3011 * flag is not set. 3012 */ 3013 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags { 3014 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT = BIT(0), 3015 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT = BIT(1), 3016 ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM = BIT(2), 3017 CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(3), 3018 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE = BIT(4), 3019 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT = BIT(5), 3020 CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT = BIT(6), 3021 }; 3022 3023 /** 3024 * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data 3025 * 3026 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 3027 * (re)association. 3028 * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is 3029 * given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc() 3030 * or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new 3031 * association requests while already associating must be rejected. 3032 * This also applies to the @links.bss parameter, which is used instead 3033 * of this one (it is %NULL) for MLO associations. 3034 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL 3035 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 3036 * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association 3037 * @crypto: crypto settings 3038 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 3039 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 3040 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 3041 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 3042 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 3043 * frame. 3044 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 3045 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 3046 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 3047 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 3048 * @vht_capa: VHT capability override 3049 * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use 3050 * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or 3051 * %NULL if FILS is not used. 3052 * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets 3053 * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association 3054 * Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts 3055 * with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce. 3056 * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override 3057 * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask 3058 * @links: per-link information for MLO connections 3059 * @link_id: >= 0 for MLO connections, where links are given, and indicates 3060 * the link on which the association request should be sent 3061 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of MLO association request, 3062 * valid iff @link_id >= 0 3063 */ 3064 struct cfg80211_assoc_request { 3065 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 3066 const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid; 3067 size_t ie_len; 3068 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 3069 bool use_mfp; 3070 u32 flags; 3071 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 3072 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 3073 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask; 3074 const u8 *fils_kek; 3075 size_t fils_kek_len; 3076 const u8 *fils_nonces; 3077 struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask; 3078 struct cfg80211_assoc_link links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 3079 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 3080 s8 link_id; 3081 }; 3082 3083 /** 3084 * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data 3085 * 3086 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 3087 * deauthentication. 3088 * 3089 * @bssid: the BSSID or AP MLD address to deauthenticate from 3090 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL 3091 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 3092 * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication 3093 * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and 3094 * do not set a deauth frame 3095 */ 3096 struct cfg80211_deauth_request { 3097 const u8 *bssid; 3098 const u8 *ie; 3099 size_t ie_len; 3100 u16 reason_code; 3101 bool local_state_change; 3102 }; 3103 3104 /** 3105 * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data 3106 * 3107 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 3108 * disassociation. 3109 * 3110 * @ap_addr: the BSSID or AP MLD address to disassociate from 3111 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL 3112 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 3113 * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation 3114 * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no 3115 * Disassociation frame is to be transmitted. 3116 */ 3117 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request { 3118 const u8 *ap_addr; 3119 const u8 *ie; 3120 size_t ie_len; 3121 u16 reason_code; 3122 bool local_state_change; 3123 }; 3124 3125 /** 3126 * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters 3127 * 3128 * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss() 3129 * method. 3130 * 3131 * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null. 3132 * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero. 3133 * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not 3134 * search for IBSSs with a different BSSID. 3135 * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found 3136 * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for 3137 * IBSSs to join on other channels. 3138 * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon 3139 * @ie_len: length of that 3140 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 3141 * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured 3142 * after joining 3143 * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 3144 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 3145 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 3146 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 3147 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 3148 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 3149 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 3150 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 3151 * to operate on DFS channels. 3152 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS 3153 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) 3154 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 3155 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 3156 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 3157 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of 3158 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys 3159 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key 3160 */ 3161 struct cfg80211_ibss_params { 3162 const u8 *ssid; 3163 const u8 *bssid; 3164 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 3165 const u8 *ie; 3166 u8 ssid_len, ie_len; 3167 u16 beacon_interval; 3168 u32 basic_rates; 3169 bool channel_fixed; 3170 bool privacy; 3171 bool control_port; 3172 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 3173 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 3174 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 3175 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 3176 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 3177 struct key_params *wep_keys; 3178 int wep_tx_key; 3179 }; 3180 3181 /** 3182 * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection. 3183 * 3184 * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour. 3185 * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour. 3186 * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF. 3187 * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST. 3188 */ 3189 struct cfg80211_bss_selection { 3190 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour; 3191 union { 3192 enum nl80211_band band_pref; 3193 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust; 3194 } param; 3195 }; 3196 3197 /** 3198 * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters 3199 * 3200 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 3201 * authentication and association. 3202 * 3203 * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based 3204 * on scan results) 3205 * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or 3206 * %NULL if not specified 3207 * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan 3208 * results) 3209 * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or 3210 * %NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is 3211 * allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS 3212 * to use. 3213 * @ssid: SSID 3214 * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets 3215 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 3216 * @ie: IEs for association request 3217 * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets 3218 * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used 3219 * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used 3220 * @crypto: crypto settings 3221 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 3222 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 3223 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 3224 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 3225 * @bg_scan_period: Background scan period in seconds 3226 * or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used. 3227 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 3228 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 3229 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 3230 * @vht_capa: VHT Capability overrides 3231 * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used. 3232 * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG 3233 * networks. 3234 * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection. 3235 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 3236 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 3237 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 3238 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 3239 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 3240 * frame. 3241 * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the 3242 * NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped 3243 * data IE. 3244 * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets. 3245 * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or 3246 * %NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and 3247 * is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 3248 * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets. 3249 * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP 3250 * messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 3251 * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional 3252 * keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified. 3253 * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets. 3254 * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver 3255 * offload of 4-way handshake. 3256 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels. 3257 * This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver 3258 * to choose from, based on BSS configuration. 3259 */ 3260 struct cfg80211_connect_params { 3261 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 3262 struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint; 3263 const u8 *bssid; 3264 const u8 *bssid_hint; 3265 const u8 *ssid; 3266 size_t ssid_len; 3267 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 3268 const u8 *ie; 3269 size_t ie_len; 3270 bool privacy; 3271 enum nl80211_mfp mfp; 3272 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 3273 const u8 *key; 3274 u8 key_len, key_idx; 3275 u32 flags; 3276 int bg_scan_period; 3277 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 3278 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 3279 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa; 3280 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask; 3281 bool pbss; 3282 struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select; 3283 const u8 *prev_bssid; 3284 const u8 *fils_erp_username; 3285 size_t fils_erp_username_len; 3286 const u8 *fils_erp_realm; 3287 size_t fils_erp_realm_len; 3288 u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num; 3289 const u8 *fils_erp_rrk; 3290 size_t fils_erp_rrk_len; 3291 bool want_1x; 3292 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 3293 }; 3294 3295 /** 3296 * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated 3297 * 3298 * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that 3299 * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call. 3300 * 3301 * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated 3302 * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm, 3303 * username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated 3304 * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated 3305 */ 3306 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed { 3307 UPDATE_ASSOC_IES = BIT(0), 3308 UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO = BIT(1), 3309 UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE = BIT(2), 3310 }; 3311 3312 /** 3313 * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values 3314 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed 3315 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed 3316 * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed 3317 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed 3318 * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed 3319 * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled 3320 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed 3321 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed 3322 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum 3323 */ 3324 enum wiphy_params_flags { 3325 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT = 1 << 0, 3326 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG = 1 << 1, 3327 WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD = 1 << 2, 3328 WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD = 1 << 3, 3329 WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS = 1 << 4, 3330 WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK = 1 << 5, 3331 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT = 1 << 6, 3332 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT = 1 << 7, 3333 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM = 1 << 8, 3334 }; 3335 3336 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT 256 3337 3338 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */ 3339 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L 5000 3340 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H 12000 3341 3342 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */ 3343 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD 24000 3344 3345 /** 3346 * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association 3347 * 3348 * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA 3349 * caching. 3350 * 3351 * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL). 3352 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 3353 * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key 3354 * derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL. 3355 * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on 3356 * the hash algorithm used to generate this. 3357 * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS 3358 * cache identifier (may be %NULL). 3359 * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets. 3360 * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the 3361 * scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be 3362 * %NULL). 3363 * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds 3364 * (dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified. 3365 * The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after 3366 * expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on 3367 * expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK 3368 * used for it expires. 3369 * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of 3370 * PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified. 3371 * Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using 3372 * this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this 3373 * threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires. 3374 */ 3375 struct cfg80211_pmksa { 3376 const u8 *bssid; 3377 const u8 *pmkid; 3378 const u8 *pmk; 3379 size_t pmk_len; 3380 const u8 *ssid; 3381 size_t ssid_len; 3382 const u8 *cache_id; 3383 u32 pmk_lifetime; 3384 u8 pmk_reauth_threshold; 3385 }; 3386 3387 /** 3388 * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern 3389 * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes, 3390 * one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211 3391 * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1 3392 * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes) 3393 * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes) 3394 * 3395 * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of 3396 * memory, free @mask only! 3397 */ 3398 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern { 3399 const u8 *mask, *pattern; 3400 int pattern_len; 3401 int pkt_offset; 3402 }; 3403 3404 /** 3405 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters 3406 * 3407 * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation 3408 * @src: source IP address 3409 * @dst: destination IP address 3410 * @dst_mac: destination MAC address 3411 * @src_port: source port 3412 * @dst_port: destination port 3413 * @payload_len: data payload length 3414 * @payload: data payload buffer 3415 * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration 3416 * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets 3417 * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length 3418 * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data 3419 * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask 3420 * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer 3421 * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration 3422 */ 3423 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp { 3424 struct socket *sock; 3425 __be32 src, dst; 3426 u16 src_port, dst_port; 3427 u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN]; 3428 int payload_len; 3429 const u8 *payload; 3430 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq; 3431 u32 data_interval; 3432 u32 wake_len; 3433 const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask; 3434 u32 tokens_size; 3435 /* must be last, variable member */ 3436 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok; 3437 }; 3438 3439 /** 3440 * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info 3441 * 3442 * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device. 3443 * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues 3444 * operating as normal during suspend 3445 * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected 3446 * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet 3447 * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern 3448 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 3449 * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure 3450 * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet 3451 * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake 3452 * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released 3453 * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h. 3454 * NULL if not configured. 3455 * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake. 3456 */ 3457 struct cfg80211_wowlan { 3458 bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 3459 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 3460 rfkill_release; 3461 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 3462 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp; 3463 int n_patterns; 3464 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config; 3465 }; 3466 3467 /** 3468 * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters 3469 * 3470 * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device. 3471 * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs. 3472 * @condition: condition for packet coalescence. 3473 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition. 3474 * @patterns: array of packet patterns 3475 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 3476 */ 3477 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules { 3478 int delay; 3479 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition; 3480 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 3481 int n_patterns; 3482 }; 3483 3484 /** 3485 * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings 3486 * 3487 * This structure defines coalescing settings. 3488 * @rules: array of coalesce rules 3489 * @n_rules: number of rules 3490 */ 3491 struct cfg80211_coalesce { 3492 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules; 3493 int n_rules; 3494 }; 3495 3496 /** 3497 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match 3498 * 3499 * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up 3500 * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred. This 3501 * value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels. 3502 * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match 3503 * occurred (in MHz) 3504 */ 3505 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match { 3506 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 3507 int n_channels; 3508 u32 channels[]; 3509 }; 3510 3511 /** 3512 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information 3513 * 3514 * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in 3515 * @matches. This value may be zero if the driver can't provide 3516 * match information. 3517 * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about 3518 * the matches that triggered the wake up. 3519 */ 3520 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info { 3521 int n_matches; 3522 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[]; 3523 }; 3524 3525 /** 3526 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report 3527 * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected 3528 * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet 3529 * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure 3530 * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet 3531 * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake 3532 * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released 3533 * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern 3534 * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data 3535 * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length 3536 * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any. 3537 * @packet_80211: For pattern match, magic packet and other data 3538 * frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for 3539 * disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which 3540 * it is. 3541 * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received 3542 * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish 3543 * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens 3544 * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect 3545 */ 3546 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup { 3547 bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 3548 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 3549 rfkill_release, packet_80211, 3550 tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens; 3551 s32 pattern_idx; 3552 u32 packet_present_len, packet_len; 3553 const void *packet; 3554 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect; 3555 }; 3556 3557 /** 3558 * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data 3559 * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes) 3560 * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes) 3561 * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes) 3562 * @kek_len: length of kek 3563 * @kck_len: length of kck 3564 * @akm: akm (oui, id) 3565 */ 3566 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data { 3567 const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr; 3568 u32 akm; 3569 u8 kek_len, kck_len; 3570 }; 3571 3572 /** 3573 * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information 3574 * 3575 * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE 3576 * 3577 * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value 3578 * @ie: Fast Transition IEs 3579 * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets 3580 */ 3581 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params { 3582 u16 md; 3583 const u8 *ie; 3584 size_t ie_len; 3585 }; 3586 3587 /** 3588 * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters 3589 * 3590 * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame 3591 * 3592 * @chan: channel to use 3593 * @offchan: indicates whether off channel operation is required 3594 * @wait: duration for ROC 3595 * @buf: buffer to transmit 3596 * @len: buffer length 3597 * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame 3598 * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack 3599 * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array 3600 * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame 3601 * @link_id: for MLO, the link ID to transmit on, -1 if not given; note 3602 * that the link ID isn't validated (much), it's in range but the 3603 * link might not exist (or be used by the receiver STA) 3604 */ 3605 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params { 3606 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 3607 bool offchan; 3608 unsigned int wait; 3609 const u8 *buf; 3610 size_t len; 3611 bool no_cck; 3612 bool dont_wait_for_ack; 3613 int n_csa_offsets; 3614 const u16 *csa_offsets; 3615 int link_id; 3616 }; 3617 3618 /** 3619 * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception 3620 * 3621 * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition 3622 * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs 3623 */ 3624 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception { 3625 u8 dscp; 3626 u8 up; 3627 }; 3628 3629 /** 3630 * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority 3631 * 3632 * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3633 * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3634 */ 3635 struct cfg80211_dscp_range { 3636 u8 low; 3637 u8 high; 3638 }; 3639 3640 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */ 3641 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX 21 3642 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN 16 3643 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \ 3644 (IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX) 3645 3646 /** 3647 * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information 3648 * 3649 * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values 3650 * 3651 * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21) 3652 * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from 3653 * the user priority DSCP range definition 3654 * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority 3655 */ 3656 struct cfg80211_qos_map { 3657 u8 num_des; 3658 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX]; 3659 struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8]; 3660 }; 3661 3662 /** 3663 * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration 3664 * 3665 * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters 3666 * 3667 * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255) 3668 * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. 3669 * For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 3670 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 3671 */ 3672 struct cfg80211_nan_conf { 3673 u8 master_pref; 3674 u8 bands; 3675 }; 3676 3677 /** 3678 * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN 3679 * configuration 3680 * 3681 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference 3682 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands 3683 */ 3684 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes { 3685 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0), 3686 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1), 3687 }; 3688 3689 /** 3690 * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter 3691 * 3692 * @filter: the content of the filter 3693 * @len: the length of the filter 3694 */ 3695 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter { 3696 const u8 *filter; 3697 u8 len; 3698 }; 3699 3700 /** 3701 * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function 3702 * 3703 * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type 3704 * @service_id: the service ID of the function 3705 * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type 3706 * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is 3707 * implementation specific. 3708 * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted 3709 * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active 3710 * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up 3711 * @followup_reqid: the requester instance ID for follow up 3712 * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up 3713 * @ttl: time to live counter in DW. 3714 * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info 3715 * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length 3716 * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive 3717 * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter 3718 * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length 3719 * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index 3720 * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses 3721 * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF 3722 * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter 3723 * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF. 3724 * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters. 3725 * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters. 3726 * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function. 3727 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier. 3728 */ 3729 struct cfg80211_nan_func { 3730 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 3731 u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN]; 3732 u8 publish_type; 3733 bool close_range; 3734 bool publish_bcast; 3735 bool subscribe_active; 3736 u8 followup_id; 3737 u8 followup_reqid; 3738 struct mac_address followup_dest; 3739 u32 ttl; 3740 const u8 *serv_spec_info; 3741 u8 serv_spec_info_len; 3742 bool srf_include; 3743 const u8 *srf_bf; 3744 u8 srf_bf_len; 3745 u8 srf_bf_idx; 3746 struct mac_address *srf_macs; 3747 int srf_num_macs; 3748 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters; 3749 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters; 3750 u8 num_tx_filters; 3751 u8 num_rx_filters; 3752 u8 instance_id; 3753 u64 cookie; 3754 }; 3755 3756 /** 3757 * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration 3758 * 3759 * @aa: authenticator address 3760 * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes. 3761 * @pmk: the PMK material 3762 * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK 3763 * is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field 3764 * holds PMK-R0. 3765 */ 3766 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf { 3767 const u8 *aa; 3768 u8 pmk_len; 3769 const u8 *pmk; 3770 const u8 *pmk_r0_name; 3771 }; 3772 3773 /** 3774 * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication. 3775 * 3776 * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces. 3777 * 3778 * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant 3779 * for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space). 3780 * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has 3781 * to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and 3782 * authentication response command interface. 3783 * @ssid: SSID of the AP. Used by both the authentication request event and 3784 * authentication response command interface. 3785 * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the 3786 * authentication request event interface. 3787 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication, 3788 * use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you 3789 * the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication 3790 * response command interface (user space to driver). 3791 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 3792 * @mld_addr: MLD address of the peer. Used by the authentication request event 3793 * interface. Driver indicates this to enable MLO during the authentication 3794 * offload to user space. Driver shall look at %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT 3795 * flag capability in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space 3796 * supports enabling MLO during the authentication offload. 3797 * User space should use the address of the interface (on which the 3798 * authentication request event reported) as self MLD address. User space 3799 * and driver should use MLD addresses in RA, TA and BSSID fields of 3800 * authentication frames sent or received via cfg80211. The driver 3801 * translates the MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link 3802 * chosen for the authentication. 3803 */ 3804 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params { 3805 enum nl80211_external_auth_action action; 3806 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3807 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 3808 unsigned int key_mgmt_suite; 3809 u16 status; 3810 const u8 *pmkid; 3811 u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3812 }; 3813 3814 /** 3815 * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics 3816 * 3817 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to 3818 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 3819 * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully 3820 * answered 3821 * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were 3822 * successfully answered 3823 * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions 3824 * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions 3825 * @non_asap_num: number of non-ASAP FTM sessions 3826 * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication 3827 * of how much time the responder was busy 3828 * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from 3829 * initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with 3830 * the responder 3831 * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks 3832 * for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot 3833 * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window 3834 */ 3835 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats { 3836 u32 filled; 3837 u32 success_num; 3838 u32 partial_num; 3839 u32 failed_num; 3840 u32 asap_num; 3841 u32 non_asap_num; 3842 u64 total_duration_ms; 3843 u32 unknown_triggers_num; 3844 u32 reschedule_requests_num; 3845 u32 out_of_window_triggers_num; 3846 }; 3847 3848 /** 3849 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result 3850 * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is 3851 * %NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise 3852 * reason than just "failure" 3853 * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index 3854 * in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported 3855 * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted 3856 * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked 3857 * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY, 3858 * fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible 3859 * by the responder 3860 * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated 3861 * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated 3862 * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated 3863 * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present) 3864 * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present) 3865 * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL) 3866 * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL) 3867 * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3868 * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3869 * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response 3870 * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame 3871 * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg) 3872 * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is 3873 * the square root of the variance) 3874 * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured 3875 * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured 3876 * (must have either this or @rtt_avg) 3877 * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance) 3878 * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread) 3879 * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid 3880 * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid 3881 * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid 3882 * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid 3883 * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid 3884 * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid 3885 * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid 3886 * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid 3887 * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid 3888 * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid 3889 * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid 3890 * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid 3891 */ 3892 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result { 3893 const u8 *lci; 3894 const u8 *civicloc; 3895 unsigned int lci_len; 3896 unsigned int civicloc_len; 3897 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason; 3898 u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes; 3899 s16 burst_index; 3900 u8 busy_retry_time; 3901 u8 num_bursts_exp; 3902 u8 burst_duration; 3903 u8 ftms_per_burst; 3904 s32 rssi_avg; 3905 s32 rssi_spread; 3906 struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate; 3907 s64 rtt_avg; 3908 s64 rtt_variance; 3909 s64 rtt_spread; 3910 s64 dist_avg; 3911 s64 dist_variance; 3912 s64 dist_spread; 3913 3914 u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1, 3915 num_ftmr_successes_valid:1, 3916 rssi_avg_valid:1, 3917 rssi_spread_valid:1, 3918 tx_rate_valid:1, 3919 rx_rate_valid:1, 3920 rtt_avg_valid:1, 3921 rtt_variance_valid:1, 3922 rtt_spread_valid:1, 3923 dist_avg_valid:1, 3924 dist_variance_valid:1, 3925 dist_spread_valid:1; 3926 }; 3927 3928 /** 3929 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result 3930 * @addr: address of the peer 3931 * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the 3932 * measurement was made) 3933 * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time 3934 * @status: status of the measurement 3935 * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not 3936 * reporting partial results always set this flag 3937 * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid 3938 * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting 3939 * one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and 3940 * they're all aggregated for userspace. 3941 * @ftm: FTM result 3942 */ 3943 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result { 3944 u64 host_time, ap_tsf; 3945 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status; 3946 3947 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 3948 3949 u8 final:1, 3950 ap_tsf_valid:1; 3951 3952 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type; 3953 3954 union { 3955 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm; 3956 }; 3957 }; 3958 3959 /** 3960 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data 3961 * @requested: indicates FTM is requested 3962 * @preamble: frame preamble to use 3963 * @burst_period: burst period to use 3964 * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode 3965 * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent 3966 * @burst_duration: burst duration 3967 * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst 3968 * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request 3969 * @request_lci: request LCI information 3970 * @request_civicloc: request civic location information 3971 * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement 3972 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 3973 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 3974 * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement 3975 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 3976 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 3977 * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either 3978 * @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set. 3979 * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to 3980 * indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if 3981 * @non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set. 3982 * 3983 * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation. 3984 */ 3985 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer { 3986 enum nl80211_preamble preamble; 3987 u16 burst_period; 3988 u8 requested:1, 3989 asap:1, 3990 request_lci:1, 3991 request_civicloc:1, 3992 trigger_based:1, 3993 non_trigger_based:1, 3994 lmr_feedback:1; 3995 u8 num_bursts_exp; 3996 u8 burst_duration; 3997 u8 ftms_per_burst; 3998 u8 ftmr_retries; 3999 u8 bss_color; 4000 }; 4001 4002 /** 4003 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request 4004 * @addr: MAC address 4005 * @chandef: channel to use 4006 * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF 4007 * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer 4008 */ 4009 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer { 4010 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 4011 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 4012 u8 report_ap_tsf:1; 4013 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm; 4014 }; 4015 4016 /** 4017 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request 4018 * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211 4019 * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211 4020 * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting, 4021 * not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211 4022 * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request 4023 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that 4024 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 4025 * be taken from the @mac_addr 4026 * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request 4027 * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if 4028 * zero it means there's no timeout 4029 * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with 4030 * @peers: per-peer measurement request data 4031 */ 4032 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request { 4033 u64 cookie; 4034 void *drv_data; 4035 u32 n_peers; 4036 u32 nl_portid; 4037 4038 u32 timeout; 4039 4040 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 4041 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 4042 4043 struct list_head list; 4044 4045 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[] __counted_by(n_peers); 4046 }; 4047 4048 /** 4049 * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information 4050 * 4051 * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE 4052 * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space. 4053 * 4054 * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces. 4055 * 4056 * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing 4057 * has to be done. 4058 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info 4059 * processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space 4060 * cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for 4061 * OWE update request command interface (user space to driver). 4062 * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are 4063 * the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and 4064 * the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface. 4065 * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets. 4066 * @assoc_link_id: MLO link ID of the AP, with which (re)association requested 4067 * by peer. This will be filled by driver for both MLO and non-MLO station 4068 * connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. For non-MLD AP mode, it 4069 * will be -1. Used only with OWE update event (driver to user space). 4070 * @peer_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the peer. For non-MLO 4071 * connection, it will be all zeros. This is applicable only when 4072 * @assoc_link_id is not -1, i.e., the AP affiliated with an MLD. Used only 4073 * with OWE update event (driver to user space). 4074 */ 4075 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info { 4076 u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 4077 u16 status; 4078 const u8 *ie; 4079 size_t ie_len; 4080 int assoc_link_id; 4081 u8 peer_mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 4082 }; 4083 4084 /** 4085 * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data 4086 * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 4087 * for the entire device 4088 * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 4089 * for the given interface 4090 * @global_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes 4091 * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface 4092 * for these subtypes 4093 */ 4094 struct mgmt_frame_regs { 4095 u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes; 4096 u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes; 4097 }; 4098 4099 /** 4100 * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration 4101 * 4102 * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks 4103 * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces. 4104 * 4105 * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0 4106 * on success or a negative error code. 4107 * 4108 * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be 4109 * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied 4110 * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering, 4111 * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers. 4112 * 4113 * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will 4114 * be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are 4115 * configured for the device. 4116 * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed 4117 * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback 4118 * to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from 4119 * the device. 4120 * 4121 * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name, 4122 * must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create 4123 * the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct 4124 * wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must 4125 * also set the address member in the wdev. 4126 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 4127 * 4128 * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface 4129 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 4130 * 4131 * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface, 4132 * keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated. 4133 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 4134 * 4135 * @add_intf_link: Add a new MLO link to the given interface. Note that 4136 * the wdev->link[] data structure has been updated, so the new link 4137 * address is available. 4138 * @del_intf_link: Remove an MLO link from the given interface. 4139 * 4140 * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL 4141 * when adding a group key. @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. 4142 * For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for 4143 * pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. 4144 * 4145 * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters. 4146 * @mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group 4147 * key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid 4148 * after it returns. This function should return an error if it is 4149 * not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist. 4150 * @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, 4151 * @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr 4152 * will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. 4153 * 4154 * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key) 4155 * and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. @link_id will 4156 * be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 4157 * for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD 4158 * address for MLO pairwise key. 4159 * 4160 * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface. @link_id will be >= 0 4161 * for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection. 4162 * 4163 * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface. 4164 * @link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection. 4165 * 4166 * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface. 4167 * @link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection. 4168 * 4169 * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver 4170 * 4171 * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters. 4172 * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode 4173 * interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started. 4174 * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing. 4175 * 4176 * @add_station: Add a new station. 4177 * @del_station: Remove a station 4178 * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much 4179 * validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags 4180 * might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check 4181 * them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call 4182 * cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information. 4183 * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac 4184 * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx 4185 * 4186 * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path 4187 * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path 4188 * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path 4189 * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters 4190 * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 4191 * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters 4192 * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 4193 * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters 4194 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4195 * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network 4196 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4197 * 4198 * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration 4199 * 4200 * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh. 4201 * The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to 4202 * set, and which to leave alone. 4203 * 4204 * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS. 4205 * 4206 * @inform_bss: Called by cfg80211 while being informed about new BSS data 4207 * for every BSS found within the reported data or frame. This is called 4208 * from within the cfg8011 inform_bss handlers while holding the bss_lock. 4209 * The data parameter is passed through from drv_data inside 4210 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss. 4211 * The new IE data for the BSS is explicitly passed. 4212 * 4213 * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters 4214 * 4215 * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas, 4216 * as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to 4217 * join the mesh instead. 4218 * 4219 * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other 4220 * interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration. 4221 * If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should 4222 * be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active. 4223 * 4224 * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given 4225 * the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done(). 4226 * For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside 4227 * the scan/scan_done bracket too. 4228 * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall 4229 * indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done(). 4230 * 4231 * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer 4232 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4233 * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer 4234 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4235 * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer 4236 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4237 * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer 4238 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4239 * 4240 * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected, 4241 * call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code 4242 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call 4243 * cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code 4244 * from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code 4245 * was received. 4246 * The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the 4247 * other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated 4248 * by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches 4249 * the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request 4250 * frame instead of Association Request frame. 4251 * The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a 4252 * specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid 4253 * parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an 4254 * indication of requesting reassociation. 4255 * In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming 4256 * cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to 4257 * cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4258 * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a 4259 * BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for 4260 * subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the 4261 * Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not 4262 * request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current 4263 * BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in 4264 * changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed. 4265 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4266 * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if 4267 * connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in 4268 * case connection was already established (invoked with the 4269 * wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout(). 4270 * 4271 * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call 4272 * cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due 4273 * to a merge. 4274 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4275 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS. 4276 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4277 * 4278 * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or 4279 * MESH mode) 4280 * 4281 * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed; 4282 * @changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values 4283 * have changed. The actual parameter values are available in 4284 * struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed. 4285 * 4286 * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters, 4287 * the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The 4288 * wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will 4289 * always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power 4290 * (as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.) 4291 * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable; 4292 * return 0 if successful 4293 * 4294 * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting 4295 * functions to adjust rfkill hw state 4296 * 4297 * @dump_survey: get site survey information. 4298 * 4299 * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified 4300 * channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel 4301 * operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is 4302 * ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event 4303 * notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel(). 4304 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation. 4305 * This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on 4306 * the duration value. 4307 * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame. 4308 * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management 4309 * frame on another channel 4310 * 4311 * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL 4312 * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be 4313 * used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally, 4314 * return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the 4315 * dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data 4316 * was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present 4317 * and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA. 4318 * 4319 * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration 4320 * 4321 * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac 4322 * devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association 4323 * RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs. 4324 * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID. 4325 * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs. 4326 * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1 4327 * allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value. 4328 * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold. 4329 * After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating 4330 * the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may 4331 * need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being 4332 * disabled.) 4333 * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the 4334 * connection quality monitor. An event is to be sent only when the 4335 * signal level is found to be outside the two values. The driver should 4336 * set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented. 4337 * If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config. 4338 * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error 4339 * thresholds. 4340 * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan. 4341 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with 4342 * given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready 4343 * for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be 4344 * called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case. 4345 * The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested 4346 * stop (when this method returns 0). 4347 * 4348 * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame 4349 * registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep. 4350 * 4351 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. 4352 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may 4353 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL 4354 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). 4355 * 4356 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). 4357 * 4358 * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame. 4359 * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup). 4360 * 4361 * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it 4362 * later passes to cfg80211_probe_status(). 4363 * 4364 * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs. 4365 * 4366 * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface. 4367 * For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single 4368 * current monitoring channel. 4369 * 4370 * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device. 4371 * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device. 4372 * 4373 * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode. 4374 * Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations 4375 * and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver 4376 * this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL 4377 * when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which 4378 * advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback. 4379 * 4380 * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver. 4381 * 4382 * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC 4383 * was finished on another phy. 4384 * 4385 * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the 4386 * driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be 4387 * used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames. 4388 * 4389 * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability 4390 * for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the 4391 * driver can take the most appropriate actions. 4392 * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link 4393 * reliability. This operation can not fail. 4394 * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters. 4395 * 4396 * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is 4397 * responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is 4398 * inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later 4399 * with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept 4400 * everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them 4401 * as soon as possible. 4402 * 4403 * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver 4404 * 4405 * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the 4406 * given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width 4407 * changes during the lifetime of the BSS. 4408 * 4409 * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device 4410 * with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by 4411 * userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into 4412 * account. 4413 * If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure 4414 * the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return 4415 * success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake 4416 * with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later 4417 * rejected) 4418 * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS 4419 * 4420 * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters 4421 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4422 * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network 4423 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4424 * 4425 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver 4426 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations 4427 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. 4428 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both 4429 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes. 4430 * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface. 4431 * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface. 4432 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure. 4433 * On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and 4434 * it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver 4435 * should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling 4436 * cfg80211_free_nan_func(). 4437 * On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the 4438 * provided @nan_func. 4439 * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function. 4440 * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must 4441 * be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes); 4442 * All other parameters must be ignored. 4443 * 4444 * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS 4445 * 4446 * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this 4447 * function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise. 4448 * 4449 * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake. 4450 * If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect 4451 * upon which the driver should clear it. 4452 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4453 * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator. 4454 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4455 * 4456 * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from 4457 * user space 4458 * 4459 * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL). The noencrypt parameter 4460 * tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted. 4461 * 4462 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available. 4463 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided. 4464 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) 4465 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement 4466 * 4467 * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME 4468 * but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated 4469 * DH IE through this interface. 4470 * 4471 * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame 4472 * and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm. 4473 * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific 4474 * This callback may sleep. 4475 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the 4476 * given TIDs. This callback may sleep. 4477 * 4478 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings. 4479 * 4480 * @color_change: Initiate a color change. 4481 * 4482 * @set_fils_aad: Set FILS AAD data to the AP driver so that the driver can use 4483 * those to decrypt (Re)Association Request and encrypt (Re)Association 4484 * Response frame. 4485 * 4486 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for 4487 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit 4488 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev. 4489 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime 4490 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected 4491 * radar channel. 4492 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to 4493 * disable background CAC/radar detection. 4494 * @add_link_station: Add a link to a station. 4495 * @mod_link_station: Modify a link of a station. 4496 * @del_link_station: Remove a link of a station. 4497 * 4498 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. 4499 */ 4500 struct cfg80211_ops { 4501 int (*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow); 4502 int (*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 4503 void (*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled); 4504 4505 struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4506 const char *name, 4507 unsigned char name_assign_type, 4508 enum nl80211_iftype type, 4509 struct vif_params *params); 4510 int (*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4511 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4512 int (*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4513 struct net_device *dev, 4514 enum nl80211_iftype type, 4515 struct vif_params *params); 4516 4517 int (*add_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4518 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4519 unsigned int link_id); 4520 void (*del_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4521 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4522 unsigned int link_id); 4523 4524 int (*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4525 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise, 4526 const u8 *mac_addr, struct key_params *params); 4527 int (*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4528 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise, 4529 const u8 *mac_addr, void *cookie, 4530 void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*)); 4531 int (*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4532 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise, 4533 const u8 *mac_addr); 4534 int (*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4535 struct net_device *netdev, int link_id, 4536 u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast); 4537 int (*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4538 struct net_device *netdev, int link_id, 4539 u8 key_index); 4540 int (*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4541 struct net_device *netdev, 4542 int link_id, 4543 u8 key_index); 4544 4545 int (*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4546 struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings); 4547 int (*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4548 struct cfg80211_ap_update *info); 4549 int (*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4550 unsigned int link_id); 4551 4552 4553 int (*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4554 const u8 *mac, 4555 struct station_parameters *params); 4556 int (*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4557 struct station_del_parameters *params); 4558 int (*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4559 const u8 *mac, 4560 struct station_parameters *params); 4561 int (*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4562 const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 4563 int (*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4564 int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 4565 4566 int (*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4567 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 4568 int (*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4569 const u8 *dst); 4570 int (*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4571 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 4572 int (*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4573 u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4574 int (*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4575 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, 4576 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4577 int (*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4578 u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4579 int (*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4580 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, 4581 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4582 int (*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4583 struct net_device *dev, 4584 struct mesh_config *conf); 4585 int (*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4586 struct net_device *dev, u32 mask, 4587 const struct mesh_config *nconf); 4588 int (*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4589 const struct mesh_config *conf, 4590 const struct mesh_setup *setup); 4591 int (*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4592 4593 int (*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4594 struct ocb_setup *setup); 4595 int (*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4596 4597 int (*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4598 struct bss_parameters *params); 4599 4600 void (*inform_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 4601 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies *ies, void *data); 4602 4603 int (*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4604 struct ieee80211_txq_params *params); 4605 4606 int (*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4607 struct net_device *dev, 4608 struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 4609 4610 int (*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4611 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4612 4613 int (*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4614 struct cfg80211_scan_request *request); 4615 void (*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4616 4617 int (*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4618 struct cfg80211_auth_request *req); 4619 int (*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4620 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req); 4621 int (*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4622 struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req); 4623 int (*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4624 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req); 4625 4626 int (*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4627 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme); 4628 int (*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4629 struct net_device *dev, 4630 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme, 4631 u32 changed); 4632 int (*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4633 u16 reason_code); 4634 4635 int (*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4636 struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params); 4637 int (*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4638 4639 int (*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4640 int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]); 4641 4642 int (*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed); 4643 4644 int (*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4645 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm); 4646 int (*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4647 int *dbm); 4648 4649 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 4650 4651 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 4652 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4653 void *data, int len); 4654 int (*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb, 4655 struct netlink_callback *cb, 4656 void *data, int len); 4657 #endif 4658 4659 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4660 struct net_device *dev, 4661 unsigned int link_id, 4662 const u8 *peer, 4663 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); 4664 4665 int (*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4666 int idx, struct survey_info *info); 4667 4668 int (*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4669 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4670 int (*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4671 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4672 int (*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev); 4673 4674 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4675 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4676 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 4677 unsigned int duration, 4678 u64 *cookie); 4679 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4680 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4681 u64 cookie); 4682 4683 int (*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4684 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params, 4685 u64 *cookie); 4686 int (*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4687 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4688 u64 cookie); 4689 4690 int (*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4691 bool enabled, int timeout); 4692 4693 int (*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4694 struct net_device *dev, 4695 s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst); 4696 4697 int (*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4698 struct net_device *dev, 4699 s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high); 4700 4701 int (*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4702 struct net_device *dev, 4703 u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl); 4704 4705 void (*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4706 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4707 struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd); 4708 4709 int (*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); 4710 int (*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); 4711 4712 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4713 struct net_device *dev, 4714 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request); 4715 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4716 u64 reqid); 4717 4718 int (*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4719 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); 4720 4721 int (*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4722 const u8 *peer, int link_id, 4723 u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, u16 status_code, 4724 u32 peer_capability, bool initiator, 4725 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4726 int (*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4727 const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper); 4728 4729 int (*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4730 const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie); 4731 4732 int (*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4733 struct net_device *dev, 4734 u16 noack_map); 4735 4736 int (*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4737 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4738 unsigned int link_id, 4739 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4740 4741 int (*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4742 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4743 void (*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4744 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4745 4746 int (*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4747 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params); 4748 4749 int (*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4750 struct net_device *dev, 4751 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 4752 u32 cac_time_ms); 4753 void (*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4754 struct net_device *dev); 4755 int (*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4756 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie); 4757 int (*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4758 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4759 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol, 4760 u16 duration); 4761 void (*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4762 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4763 int (*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4764 struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce); 4765 4766 int (*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4767 struct net_device *dev, 4768 struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params); 4769 4770 int (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4771 struct net_device *dev, 4772 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 4773 4774 int (*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4775 unsigned int link_id, 4776 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4777 4778 int (*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4779 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio, 4780 u16 admitted_time); 4781 int (*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4782 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer); 4783 4784 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4785 struct net_device *dev, 4786 const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class, 4787 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4788 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4789 struct net_device *dev, 4790 const u8 *addr); 4791 int (*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4792 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf); 4793 void (*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4794 int (*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4795 struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func); 4796 void (*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4797 u64 cookie); 4798 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4799 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4800 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, 4801 u32 changes); 4802 4803 int (*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4804 struct net_device *dev, 4805 const bool enabled); 4806 4807 int (*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4808 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4809 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats); 4810 4811 int (*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4812 const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf); 4813 int (*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4814 const u8 *aa); 4815 int (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4816 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params); 4817 4818 int (*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4819 struct net_device *dev, 4820 const u8 *buf, size_t len, 4821 const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto, 4822 const bool noencrypt, int link_id, 4823 u64 *cookie); 4824 4825 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4826 struct net_device *dev, 4827 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats); 4828 4829 int (*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4830 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4831 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4832 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4833 int (*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4834 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info); 4835 int (*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4836 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4837 int (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4838 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf); 4839 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4840 const u8 *peer, u8 tids); 4841 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4842 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar); 4843 int (*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4844 struct net_device *dev, 4845 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params); 4846 int (*set_fils_aad)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4847 struct cfg80211_fils_aad *fils_aad); 4848 int (*set_radar_background)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4849 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4850 int (*add_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4851 struct link_station_parameters *params); 4852 int (*mod_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4853 struct link_station_parameters *params); 4854 int (*del_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4855 struct link_station_del_parameters *params); 4856 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4857 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts); 4858 }; 4859 4860 /* 4861 * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures 4862 * and registration/helper functions 4863 */ 4864 4865 /** 4866 * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags 4867 * 4868 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split 4869 * into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB. 4870 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this 4871 * wiphy at all 4872 * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled 4873 * by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default 4874 * on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good 4875 * reason to override the default 4876 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station 4877 * on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of 4878 * supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype. 4879 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station 4880 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the 4881 * control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the 4882 * control_port_no_encrypt flag. 4883 * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN. 4884 * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing 4885 * auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH. 4886 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the 4887 * firmware. 4888 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP. 4889 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation. 4890 * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z) 4891 * link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and 4892 * teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT 4893 * command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be 4894 * used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation. 4895 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME 4896 * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes 4897 * when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling 4898 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(). 4899 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device 4900 * responds to probe-requests in hardware. 4901 * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX. 4902 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call. 4903 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels. 4904 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in 4905 * beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...). 4906 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys 4907 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO: This is a temporary flag gating the MLO APIs, 4908 * in order to not have them reachable in normal drivers, until we have 4909 * complete feature/interface combinations/etc. advertisement. No driver 4910 * should set this flag for now. 4911 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32: The device supports 32-byte KCK keys. 4912 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER: The device could handle reg notify for 4913 * NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER. 4914 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON: reg_call_notifier() is called if driver 4915 * set this flag to update channels on beacon hints. 4916 */ 4917 enum wiphy_flags { 4918 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK = BIT(0), 4919 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO = BIT(1), 4920 WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ = BIT(2), 4921 WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK = BIT(3), 4922 WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT = BIT(4), 4923 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP = BIT(5), 4924 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION = BIT(6), 4925 WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL = BIT(7), 4926 WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN = BIT(8), 4927 WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH = BIT(10), 4928 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32 = BIT(11), 4929 /* use hole at 12 */ 4930 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM = BIT(13), 4931 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD = BIT(14), 4932 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS = BIT(15), 4933 WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP = BIT(16), 4934 WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME = BIT(17), 4935 WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS = BIT(18), 4936 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD = BIT(19), 4937 WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX = BIT(20), 4938 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL = BIT(21), 4939 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ = BIT(22), 4940 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = BIT(23), 4941 WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER = BIT(24), 4942 WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON = BIT(25), 4943 }; 4944 4945 /** 4946 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types 4947 * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types 4948 * @types: interface types (bits) 4949 */ 4950 struct ieee80211_iface_limit { 4951 u16 max; 4952 u16 types; 4953 }; 4954 4955 /** 4956 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination 4957 * 4958 * With this structure the driver can describe which interface 4959 * combinations it supports concurrently. 4960 * 4961 * Examples: 4962 * 4963 * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total: 4964 * 4965 * .. code-block:: c 4966 * 4967 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = { 4968 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 4969 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP), }, 4970 * }; 4971 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = { 4972 * .limits = limits1, 4973 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1), 4974 * .max_interfaces = 2, 4975 * .beacon_int_infra_match = true, 4976 * }; 4977 * 4978 * 4979 * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total: 4980 * 4981 * .. code-block:: c 4982 * 4983 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = { 4984 * { .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) | 4985 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), }, 4986 * }; 4987 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = { 4988 * .limits = limits2, 4989 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2), 4990 * .max_interfaces = 8, 4991 * .num_different_channels = 1, 4992 * }; 4993 * 4994 * 4995 * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total. 4996 * 4997 * This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections. 4998 * 4999 * .. code-block:: c 5000 * 5001 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = { 5002 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 5003 * { .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) | 5004 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), }, 5005 * }; 5006 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = { 5007 * .limits = limits3, 5008 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3), 5009 * .max_interfaces = 4, 5010 * .num_different_channels = 2, 5011 * }; 5012 * 5013 */ 5014 struct ieee80211_iface_combination { 5015 /** 5016 * @limits: 5017 * limits for the given interface types 5018 */ 5019 const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits; 5020 5021 /** 5022 * @num_different_channels: 5023 * can use up to this many different channels 5024 */ 5025 u32 num_different_channels; 5026 5027 /** 5028 * @max_interfaces: 5029 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group 5030 */ 5031 u16 max_interfaces; 5032 5033 /** 5034 * @n_limits: 5035 * number of limitations 5036 */ 5037 u8 n_limits; 5038 5039 /** 5040 * @beacon_int_infra_match: 5041 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure 5042 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases. 5043 */ 5044 bool beacon_int_infra_match; 5045 5046 /** 5047 * @radar_detect_widths: 5048 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection 5049 */ 5050 u8 radar_detect_widths; 5051 5052 /** 5053 * @radar_detect_regions: 5054 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection 5055 */ 5056 u8 radar_detect_regions; 5057 5058 /** 5059 * @beacon_int_min_gcd: 5060 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals. 5061 * 5062 * = 0 5063 * all beacon intervals for different interface must be same. 5064 * > 0 5065 * any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND 5066 * GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this 5067 * combination must be greater or equal to this value. 5068 */ 5069 u32 beacon_int_min_gcd; 5070 }; 5071 5072 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes { 5073 u16 tx, rx; 5074 }; 5075 5076 /** 5077 * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags 5078 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any" 5079 * trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and 5080 * wakes up the host on any activity, for example a 5081 * received packet that passed filtering; note that the 5082 * packet should be preserved in that case 5083 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet 5084 * (see nl80211.h) 5085 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect 5086 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep 5087 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure 5088 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request 5089 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure 5090 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release 5091 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection 5092 */ 5093 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags { 5094 WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY = BIT(0), 5095 WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT = BIT(1), 5096 WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT = BIT(2), 5097 WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY = BIT(3), 5098 WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE = BIT(4), 5099 WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ = BIT(5), 5100 WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE = BIT(6), 5101 WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE = BIT(7), 5102 WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT = BIT(8), 5103 }; 5104 5105 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support { 5106 const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok; 5107 u32 data_payload_max; 5108 u32 data_interval_max; 5109 u32 wake_payload_max; 5110 bool seq; 5111 }; 5112 5113 /** 5114 * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data 5115 * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags 5116 * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns 5117 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 5118 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 5119 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 5120 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 5121 * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect, 5122 * similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for 5123 * scheduled scans. 5124 * See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more 5125 * details. 5126 * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information 5127 */ 5128 struct wiphy_wowlan_support { 5129 u32 flags; 5130 int n_patterns; 5131 int pattern_max_len; 5132 int pattern_min_len; 5133 int max_pkt_offset; 5134 int max_nd_match_sets; 5135 const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp; 5136 }; 5137 5138 /** 5139 * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data 5140 * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules 5141 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs 5142 * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule 5143 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 5144 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 5145 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 5146 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 5147 */ 5148 struct wiphy_coalesce_support { 5149 int n_rules; 5150 int max_delay; 5151 int n_patterns; 5152 int pattern_max_len; 5153 int pattern_min_len; 5154 int max_pkt_offset; 5155 }; 5156 5157 /** 5158 * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands 5159 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev 5160 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev 5161 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running 5162 * (must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV) 5163 */ 5164 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags { 5165 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0), 5166 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1), 5167 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2), 5168 }; 5169 5170 /** 5171 * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags 5172 * 5173 * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed 5174 * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed 5175 * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed 5176 * 5177 */ 5178 enum wiphy_opmode_flag { 5179 STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0), 5180 STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED = BIT(1), 5181 STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED = BIT(2), 5182 }; 5183 5184 /** 5185 * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information 5186 * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag 5187 * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station 5188 * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station 5189 * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station 5190 */ 5191 5192 struct sta_opmode_info { 5193 u32 changed; 5194 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 5195 enum nl80211_chan_width bw; 5196 u8 rx_nss; 5197 }; 5198 5199 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA)) 5200 5201 /** 5202 * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition 5203 * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211 5204 * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags 5205 * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the 5206 * flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data 5207 * pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all 5208 * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The 5209 * @storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple 5210 * dumpit calls. 5211 * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA. 5212 * Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the 5213 * attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command). 5214 * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy 5215 * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and 5216 * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others 5217 * are used with dump requests. 5218 */ 5219 struct wiphy_vendor_command { 5220 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info; 5221 u32 flags; 5222 int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 5223 const void *data, int data_len); 5224 int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 5225 struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len, 5226 unsigned long *storage); 5227 const struct nla_policy *policy; 5228 unsigned int maxattr; 5229 }; 5230 5231 /** 5232 * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type 5233 * @iftype: interface type 5234 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 5235 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the 5236 * 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are 5237 * in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std 5238 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. 5239 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 5240 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 5241 * @eml_capabilities: EML capabilities (for MLO) 5242 * @mld_capa_and_ops: MLD capabilities and operations (for MLO) 5243 */ 5244 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab { 5245 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 5246 const u8 *extended_capabilities; 5247 const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask; 5248 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 5249 u16 eml_capabilities; 5250 u16 mld_capa_and_ops; 5251 }; 5252 5253 /** 5254 * cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa - lookup interface type extended capability 5255 * @wiphy: the wiphy to look up from 5256 * @type: the interface type to look up 5257 */ 5258 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab * 5259 cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype type); 5260 5261 /** 5262 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities 5263 * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement 5264 * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement 5265 * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement 5266 * @ftm: FTM measurement data 5267 * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported 5268 * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported 5269 * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported 5270 * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data 5271 * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data 5272 * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble) 5273 * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width) 5274 * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported 5275 * (set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily 5276 * forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick) 5277 * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if 5278 * not limited) 5279 * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported 5280 * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported 5281 */ 5282 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities { 5283 unsigned int max_peers; 5284 u8 report_ap_tsf:1, 5285 randomize_mac_addr:1; 5286 5287 struct { 5288 u32 preambles; 5289 u32 bandwidths; 5290 s8 max_bursts_exponent; 5291 u8 max_ftms_per_burst; 5292 u8 supported:1, 5293 asap:1, 5294 non_asap:1, 5295 request_lci:1, 5296 request_civicloc:1, 5297 trigger_based:1, 5298 non_trigger_based:1; 5299 } ftm; 5300 }; 5301 5302 /** 5303 * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm 5304 * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the 5305 * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites. 5306 * 5307 * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types 5308 * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites 5309 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 5310 */ 5311 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites { 5312 u16 iftypes_mask; 5313 const u32 *akm_suites; 5314 int n_akm_suites; 5315 }; 5316 5317 #define CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS 0xffff 5318 5319 /** 5320 * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description 5321 * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device 5322 * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback, 5323 * note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory() 5324 * the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL 5325 * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via 5326 * the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver 5327 * on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future 5328 * regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers. 5329 * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss. 5330 * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites 5331 * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites 5332 * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if 5333 * the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in 5334 * iftype_akm_suites. 5335 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 5336 * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type. 5337 * Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot 5338 * overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all 5339 * instances of iftype_akm_suites). 5340 * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm 5341 * suites are specified separately. 5342 * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit) 5343 * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit) 5344 * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold); 5345 * -1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used 5346 * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled 5347 * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in 5348 * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device 5349 * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking, 5350 * set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last 5351 * four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual 5352 * variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with 5353 * interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up. 5354 * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses. 5355 * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer 5356 * to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used 5357 * by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to 5358 * all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle 5359 * the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses. 5360 * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against 5361 * unregister hardware 5362 * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>). 5363 * It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames 5364 * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in 5365 * /sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev() 5366 * (see below). 5367 * @wext: wireless extension handlers 5368 * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter) 5369 * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy, 5370 * must be set by driver 5371 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not 5372 * list single interface types. 5373 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array. 5374 * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not 5375 * subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW. 5376 * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags 5377 * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see 5378 * &enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags 5379 * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags. 5380 * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see 5381 * &enum nl80211_ext_feature_index. 5382 * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it, 5383 * this variable determines its size 5384 * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in 5385 * any given scan 5386 * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that 5387 * the device can run concurrently. 5388 * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan 5389 * for in any given scheduled scan 5390 * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle 5391 * when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not 5392 * supported. 5393 * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can 5394 * add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not 5395 * include fixed IEs like supported rates 5396 * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled 5397 * scans 5398 * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number 5399 * of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device. 5400 * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a 5401 * single scan plan supported by the device. 5402 * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single 5403 * scan plan supported by the device. 5404 * @coverage_class: current coverage class 5405 * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting 5406 * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting 5407 * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device 5408 * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary 5409 * wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers 5410 * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device 5411 * 5412 * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or 5413 * transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface 5414 * type 5415 * 5416 * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 5417 * configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 5418 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set. 5419 * 5420 * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 5421 * configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 5422 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set. 5423 * 5424 * @probe_resp_offload: 5425 * Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading. 5426 * See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid 5427 * when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set. 5428 * 5429 * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation 5430 * may request, if implemented. 5431 * 5432 * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information 5433 * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be 5434 * used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed 5435 * to the suspend() operation instead. 5436 * 5437 * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features. 5438 * @ht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden. 5439 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 5440 * @vht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden. 5441 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 5442 * 5443 * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must 5444 * not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection. 5445 * 5446 * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device 5447 * supports for ACL. 5448 * 5449 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 5450 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are 5451 * the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") 5452 * and are in the same format as in the information element. See 5453 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default 5454 * extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified 5455 * for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab. 5456 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 5457 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 5458 * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type 5459 * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended 5460 * capabilities are specified separately. 5461 * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information 5462 * 5463 * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware 5464 * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands 5465 * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware 5466 * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events 5467 * 5468 * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode 5469 * (including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The 5470 * driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in 5471 * some cases, but may not always reach. 5472 * 5473 * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons 5474 * and probe responses. This value should be set if the driver 5475 * wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means 5476 * infinite. 5477 * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported 5478 * by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the 5479 * attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr. 5480 * 5481 * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a 5482 * bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. For instance, for 5483 * NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 5484 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 5485 * 5486 * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit 5487 * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit 5488 * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum 5489 * 5490 * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using 5491 * wake_tx_queue 5492 * 5493 * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP 5494 * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not 5495 * HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues. 5496 * @support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect. 5497 * 5498 * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities 5499 * 5500 * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the 5501 * device has 5502 * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 5503 * supported by the driver for each vif 5504 * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 5505 * supported by the driver for each peer 5506 * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for 5507 * long/short retry configuration 5508 * 5509 * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for 5510 * configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and 5511 * %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes 5512 * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities 5513 * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure 5514 * 5515 * @mbssid_max_interfaces: maximum number of interfaces supported by the driver 5516 * in a multiple BSSID set. This field must be set to a non-zero value 5517 * by the driver to advertise MBSSID support. 5518 * @ema_max_profile_periodicity: maximum profile periodicity supported by 5519 * the driver. Setting this field to a non-zero value indicates that the 5520 * driver supports enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP). 5521 * @max_num_akm_suites: maximum number of AKM suites allowed for 5522 * configuration through %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and 5523 * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP. Set to NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES if not set by 5524 * driver. If set by driver minimum allowed value is 5525 * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES in order to avoid compatibility issues with 5526 * legacy userspace and maximum allowed value is 5527 * CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES. 5528 * 5529 * @hw_timestamp_max_peers: maximum number of peers that the driver supports 5530 * enabling HW timestamping for concurrently. Setting this field to a 5531 * non-zero value indicates that the driver supports HW timestamping. 5532 * A value of %CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS indicates the driver 5533 * supports enabling HW timestamping for all peers (i.e. no need to 5534 * specify a mac address). 5535 */ 5536 struct wiphy { 5537 struct mutex mtx; 5538 5539 /* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */ 5540 5541 u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN]; 5542 u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN]; 5543 5544 struct mac_address *addresses; 5545 5546 const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes; 5547 5548 const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations; 5549 int n_iface_combinations; 5550 u16 software_iftypes; 5551 5552 u16 n_addresses; 5553 5554 /* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */ 5555 u16 interface_modes; 5556 5557 u16 max_acl_mac_addrs; 5558 5559 u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features; 5560 u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)]; 5561 5562 u32 ap_sme_capa; 5563 5564 enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type; 5565 5566 int bss_priv_size; 5567 u8 max_scan_ssids; 5568 u8 max_sched_scan_reqs; 5569 u8 max_sched_scan_ssids; 5570 u8 max_match_sets; 5571 u16 max_scan_ie_len; 5572 u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len; 5573 u32 max_sched_scan_plans; 5574 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval; 5575 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations; 5576 5577 int n_cipher_suites; 5578 const u32 *cipher_suites; 5579 5580 int n_akm_suites; 5581 const u32 *akm_suites; 5582 5583 const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites; 5584 unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites; 5585 5586 u8 retry_short; 5587 u8 retry_long; 5588 u32 frag_threshold; 5589 u32 rts_threshold; 5590 u8 coverage_class; 5591 5592 char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN]; 5593 u32 hw_version; 5594 5595 #ifdef CONFIG_PM 5596 const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan; 5597 struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config; 5598 #endif 5599 5600 u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration; 5601 5602 u8 max_num_pmkids; 5603 5604 u32 available_antennas_tx; 5605 u32 available_antennas_rx; 5606 5607 u32 probe_resp_offload; 5608 5609 const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask; 5610 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 5611 5612 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab; 5613 unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab; 5614 5615 const void *privid; 5616 5617 struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 5618 5619 void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5620 struct regulatory_request *request); 5621 5622 /* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */ 5623 5624 const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd; 5625 5626 struct device dev; 5627 5628 bool registered; 5629 5630 struct dentry *debugfsdir; 5631 5632 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask; 5633 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask; 5634 5635 struct list_head wdev_list; 5636 5637 possible_net_t _net; 5638 5639 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 5640 const struct iw_handler_def *wext; 5641 #endif 5642 5643 const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce; 5644 5645 const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands; 5646 const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events; 5647 int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events; 5648 5649 u16 max_ap_assoc_sta; 5650 5651 u8 max_num_csa_counters; 5652 5653 u32 bss_select_support; 5654 5655 u8 nan_supported_bands; 5656 5657 u32 txq_limit; 5658 u32 txq_memory_limit; 5659 u32 txq_quantum; 5660 5661 unsigned long tx_queue_len; 5662 5663 u8 support_mbssid:1, 5664 support_only_he_mbssid:1; 5665 5666 const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa; 5667 5668 struct { 5669 u64 peer, vif; 5670 u8 max_retry; 5671 } tid_config_support; 5672 5673 u8 max_data_retry_count; 5674 5675 const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa; 5676 5677 struct rfkill *rfkill; 5678 5679 u8 mbssid_max_interfaces; 5680 u8 ema_max_profile_periodicity; 5681 u16 max_num_akm_suites; 5682 5683 u16 hw_timestamp_max_peers; 5684 5685 char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN); 5686 }; 5687 5688 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5689 { 5690 return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net); 5691 } 5692 5693 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net) 5694 { 5695 write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net); 5696 } 5697 5698 /** 5699 * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy 5700 * 5701 * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return 5702 * Return: The priv of @wiphy. 5703 */ 5704 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5705 { 5706 BUG_ON(!wiphy); 5707 return &wiphy->priv; 5708 } 5709 5710 /** 5711 * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv 5712 * 5713 * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv 5714 * Return: The wiphy of @priv. 5715 */ 5716 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv) 5717 { 5718 BUG_ON(!priv); 5719 return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv); 5720 } 5721 5722 /** 5723 * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy 5724 * 5725 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind 5726 * @dev: The device to parent it to 5727 */ 5728 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev) 5729 { 5730 wiphy->dev.parent = dev; 5731 } 5732 5733 /** 5734 * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer 5735 * 5736 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up 5737 * Return: The dev of @wiphy. 5738 */ 5739 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5740 { 5741 return wiphy->dev.parent; 5742 } 5743 5744 /** 5745 * wiphy_name - get wiphy name 5746 * 5747 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return 5748 * Return: The name of @wiphy. 5749 */ 5750 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy) 5751 { 5752 return dev_name(&wiphy->dev); 5753 } 5754 5755 /** 5756 * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5757 * 5758 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5759 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5760 * @requested_name: Request a particular name. 5761 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming. 5762 * 5763 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5764 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5765 * 5766 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5767 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5768 */ 5769 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv, 5770 const char *requested_name); 5771 5772 /** 5773 * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5774 * 5775 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5776 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5777 * 5778 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5779 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5780 * 5781 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5782 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5783 */ 5784 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, 5785 int sizeof_priv) 5786 { 5787 return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL); 5788 } 5789 5790 /** 5791 * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211 5792 * 5793 * @wiphy: The wiphy to register. 5794 * 5795 * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code. 5796 */ 5797 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5798 5799 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */ 5800 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx) 5801 5802 /** 5803 * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking 5804 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on 5805 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing 5806 * 5807 * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock() 5808 * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference(). 5809 */ 5810 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p) \ 5811 rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx)) 5812 5813 /** 5814 * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx 5815 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on 5816 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing 5817 * 5818 * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the 5819 * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates. 5820 */ 5821 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p) \ 5822 rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx)) 5823 5824 /** 5825 * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy 5826 * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from 5827 */ 5828 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5829 5830 /** 5831 * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211 5832 * 5833 * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister. 5834 * 5835 * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv 5836 * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding 5837 * request that is being handled. 5838 */ 5839 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5840 5841 /** 5842 * wiphy_free - free wiphy 5843 * 5844 * @wiphy: The wiphy to free 5845 */ 5846 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5847 5848 /* internal structs */ 5849 struct cfg80211_conn; 5850 struct cfg80211_internal_bss; 5851 struct cfg80211_cached_keys; 5852 struct cfg80211_cqm_config; 5853 5854 /** 5855 * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy 5856 * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock 5857 * 5858 * This is needed around registering and unregistering netdevs that 5859 * aren't created through cfg80211 calls, since that requires locking 5860 * in cfg80211 when the notifiers is called, but that cannot 5861 * differentiate which way it's called. 5862 * 5863 * It can also be used by drivers for their own purposes. 5864 * 5865 * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked. 5866 * 5867 * Note that this makes sure that no workers that have been queued 5868 * with wiphy_queue_work() are running. 5869 */ 5870 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5871 __acquires(&wiphy->mtx) 5872 { 5873 mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx); 5874 __acquire(&wiphy->mtx); 5875 } 5876 5877 /** 5878 * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again 5879 * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock 5880 */ 5881 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5882 __releases(&wiphy->mtx) 5883 { 5884 __release(&wiphy->mtx); 5885 mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx); 5886 } 5887 5888 struct wiphy_work; 5889 typedef void (*wiphy_work_func_t)(struct wiphy *, struct wiphy_work *); 5890 5891 struct wiphy_work { 5892 struct list_head entry; 5893 wiphy_work_func_t func; 5894 }; 5895 5896 static inline void wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work *work, 5897 wiphy_work_func_t func) 5898 { 5899 INIT_LIST_HEAD(&work->entry); 5900 work->func = func; 5901 } 5902 5903 /** 5904 * wiphy_work_queue - queue work for the wiphy 5905 * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for 5906 * @work: the work item 5907 * 5908 * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work 5909 * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be 5910 * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running 5911 * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can 5912 * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires 5913 * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock(). 5914 */ 5915 void wiphy_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work); 5916 5917 /** 5918 * wiphy_work_cancel - cancel previously queued work 5919 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes 5920 * @work: the work to cancel 5921 * 5922 * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being 5923 * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). 5924 */ 5925 void wiphy_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work); 5926 5927 /** 5928 * wiphy_work_flush - flush previously queued work 5929 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes 5930 * @work: the work to flush, this can be %NULL to flush all work 5931 * 5932 * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called 5933 * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). 5934 */ 5935 void wiphy_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work); 5936 5937 struct wiphy_delayed_work { 5938 struct wiphy_work work; 5939 struct wiphy *wiphy; 5940 struct timer_list timer; 5941 }; 5942 5943 void wiphy_delayed_work_timer(struct timer_list *t); 5944 5945 static inline void wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork, 5946 wiphy_work_func_t func) 5947 { 5948 timer_setup(&dwork->timer, wiphy_delayed_work_timer, 0); 5949 wiphy_work_init(&dwork->work, func); 5950 } 5951 5952 /** 5953 * wiphy_delayed_work_queue - queue delayed work for the wiphy 5954 * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for 5955 * @dwork: the delayable worker 5956 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing 5957 * 5958 * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work 5959 * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be 5960 * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running 5961 * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can 5962 * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires 5963 * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock(). 5964 */ 5965 void wiphy_delayed_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5966 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork, 5967 unsigned long delay); 5968 5969 /** 5970 * wiphy_delayed_work_cancel - cancel previously queued delayed work 5971 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes 5972 * @dwork: the delayed work to cancel 5973 * 5974 * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being 5975 * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). 5976 */ 5977 void wiphy_delayed_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5978 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork); 5979 5980 /** 5981 * wiphy_delayed_work_flush - flush previously queued delayed work 5982 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes 5983 * @dwork: the delayed work to flush 5984 * 5985 * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called 5986 * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). 5987 */ 5988 void wiphy_delayed_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5989 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork); 5990 5991 /** 5992 * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state 5993 * 5994 * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver 5995 * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this 5996 * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.) 5997 * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will 5998 * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device, 5999 * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or 6000 * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops 6001 * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.) 6002 * 6003 * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver 6004 * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as 6005 * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be 6006 * allocated outside of callback operations that return it. 6007 * 6008 * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description 6009 * @iftype: interface type 6010 * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211 6011 * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock 6012 * for the notifier 6013 * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces 6014 * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL 6015 * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this 6016 * wireless device if it has no netdev 6017 * @u: union containing data specific to @iftype 6018 * @connected: indicates if connected or not (STA mode) 6019 * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 6020 * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code 6021 * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling 6022 * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data 6023 * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data 6024 * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association 6025 * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements 6026 * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID 6027 * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID 6028 * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index 6029 * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index 6030 * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation 6031 * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity 6032 * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be 6033 * set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the 6034 * netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update 6035 * by cfg80211 on change_interface 6036 * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames 6037 * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated, 6038 * need to propagate the update to the driver 6039 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting 6040 * beacons, 0 when not valid 6041 * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL 6042 * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g. 6043 * the P2P Device. 6044 * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started 6045 * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 6046 * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms 6047 * @ps: powersave mode is enabled 6048 * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout 6049 * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application 6050 * registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode) 6051 * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data 6052 * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established 6053 * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type 6054 * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID 6055 * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work 6056 * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect 6057 * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing 6058 * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list 6059 * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID 6060 * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away 6061 * @cqm_rssi_work: (private) CQM RSSI reporting work 6062 * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state 6063 * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests 6064 * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock 6065 * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work 6066 * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last 6067 * unprotected beacon report 6068 * @links: array of %IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS elements containing @addr 6069 * @ap and @client for each link 6070 * @valid_links: bitmap describing what elements of @links are valid 6071 */ 6072 struct wireless_dev { 6073 struct wiphy *wiphy; 6074 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 6075 6076 /* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */ 6077 struct list_head list; 6078 struct net_device *netdev; 6079 6080 u32 identifier; 6081 6082 struct list_head mgmt_registrations; 6083 u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1; 6084 6085 bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering; 6086 6087 u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16)); 6088 6089 /* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */ 6090 struct cfg80211_conn *conn; 6091 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys; 6092 enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type; 6093 u32 conn_owner_nlportid; 6094 6095 struct work_struct disconnect_wk; 6096 u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 6097 6098 struct list_head event_list; 6099 spinlock_t event_lock; 6100 6101 u8 connected:1; 6102 6103 bool ps; 6104 int ps_timeout; 6105 6106 u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid; 6107 6108 u32 owner_nlportid; 6109 bool nl_owner_dead; 6110 6111 /* FIXME: need to rework radar detection for MLO */ 6112 bool cac_started; 6113 unsigned long cac_start_time; 6114 unsigned int cac_time_ms; 6115 6116 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 6117 /* wext data */ 6118 struct { 6119 struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss; 6120 struct cfg80211_connect_params connect; 6121 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys; 6122 const u8 *ie; 6123 size_t ie_len; 6124 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 6125 u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 6126 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 6127 s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key; 6128 bool prev_bssid_valid; 6129 } wext; 6130 #endif 6131 6132 struct wiphy_work cqm_rssi_work; 6133 struct cfg80211_cqm_config __rcu *cqm_config; 6134 6135 struct list_head pmsr_list; 6136 spinlock_t pmsr_lock; 6137 struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk; 6138 6139 unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported; 6140 6141 union { 6142 struct { 6143 u8 connected_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 6144 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 6145 u8 ssid_len; 6146 } client; 6147 struct { 6148 int beacon_interval; 6149 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef; 6150 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 6151 u8 id[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 6152 u8 id_len, id_up_len; 6153 } mesh; 6154 struct { 6155 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef; 6156 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 6157 u8 ssid_len; 6158 } ap; 6159 struct { 6160 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; 6161 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 6162 int beacon_interval; 6163 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 6164 u8 ssid_len; 6165 } ibss; 6166 struct { 6167 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 6168 } ocb; 6169 } u; 6170 6171 struct { 6172 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 6173 union { 6174 struct { 6175 unsigned int beacon_interval; 6176 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 6177 } ap; 6178 struct { 6179 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; 6180 } client; 6181 }; 6182 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 6183 u16 valid_links; 6184 }; 6185 6186 static inline const u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 6187 { 6188 if (wdev->netdev) 6189 return wdev->netdev->dev_addr; 6190 return wdev->address; 6191 } 6192 6193 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 6194 { 6195 if (wdev->netdev) 6196 return netif_running(wdev->netdev); 6197 return wdev->is_running; 6198 } 6199 6200 /** 6201 * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev 6202 * 6203 * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return 6204 * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev. 6205 */ 6206 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 6207 { 6208 BUG_ON(!wdev); 6209 return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy); 6210 } 6211 6212 /** 6213 * wdev_chandef - return chandef pointer from wireless_dev 6214 * @wdev: the wdev 6215 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO 6216 * 6217 * Return: The chandef depending on the mode, or %NULL. 6218 */ 6219 struct cfg80211_chan_def *wdev_chandef(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6220 unsigned int link_id); 6221 6222 static inline void WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6223 unsigned int link_id) 6224 { 6225 WARN_ON(link_id && !wdev->valid_links); 6226 WARN_ON(wdev->valid_links && 6227 !(wdev->valid_links & BIT(link_id))); 6228 } 6229 6230 #define for_each_valid_link(link_info, link_id) \ 6231 for (link_id = 0; \ 6232 link_id < ((link_info)->valid_links ? \ 6233 ARRAY_SIZE((link_info)->links) : 1); \ 6234 link_id++) \ 6235 if (!(link_info)->valid_links || \ 6236 ((link_info)->valid_links & BIT(link_id))) 6237 6238 /** 6239 * DOC: Utility functions 6240 * 6241 * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful. 6242 */ 6243 6244 /** 6245 * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel 6246 * 6247 * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel 6248 * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel 6249 * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b 6250 */ 6251 static inline bool 6252 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a, 6253 struct ieee80211_channel *b) 6254 { 6255 return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq && 6256 a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset); 6257 } 6258 6259 /** 6260 * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz 6261 * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert 6262 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz) 6263 */ 6264 static inline u32 6265 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 6266 { 6267 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset; 6268 } 6269 6270 /** 6271 * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan 6272 * 6273 * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ 6274 * @chan: channel 6275 * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq 6276 */ 6277 enum nl80211_chan_width 6278 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 6279 6280 /** 6281 * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency 6282 * @chan: channel number 6283 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 6284 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 6285 */ 6286 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band); 6287 6288 /** 6289 * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency 6290 * @chan: channel number 6291 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 6292 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 6293 */ 6294 static inline int 6295 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band) 6296 { 6297 return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band)); 6298 } 6299 6300 /** 6301 * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 6302 * @freq: center frequency in KHz 6303 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 6304 */ 6305 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq); 6306 6307 /** 6308 * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 6309 * @freq: center frequency in MHz 6310 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 6311 */ 6312 static inline int 6313 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq) 6314 { 6315 return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 6316 } 6317 6318 /** 6319 * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified 6320 * frequency 6321 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 6322 * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel 6323 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 6324 */ 6325 struct ieee80211_channel * 6326 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq); 6327 6328 /** 6329 * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency 6330 * 6331 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 6332 * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel 6333 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 6334 */ 6335 static inline struct ieee80211_channel * 6336 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq) 6337 { 6338 return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 6339 } 6340 6341 /** 6342 * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC 6343 * @chan: control channel to check 6344 * 6345 * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in 6346 * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3 6347 */ 6348 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 6349 { 6350 if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ) 6351 return false; 6352 6353 return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5; 6354 } 6355 6356 /** 6357 * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate 6358 * 6359 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 6360 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates 6361 * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate 6362 * 6363 * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that 6364 * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map, 6365 * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of 6366 * rates in the band's bitrate table. 6367 */ 6368 const struct ieee80211_rate * 6369 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6370 u32 basic_rates, int bitrate); 6371 6372 /** 6373 * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band 6374 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 6375 * 6376 * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given 6377 * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array. 6378 */ 6379 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband); 6380 6381 /* 6382 * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support 6383 * 6384 * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c 6385 * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst 6386 */ 6387 6388 struct radiotap_align_size { 6389 uint8_t align:4, size:4; 6390 }; 6391 6392 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace { 6393 const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size; 6394 int n_bits; 6395 uint32_t oui; 6396 uint8_t subns; 6397 }; 6398 6399 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces { 6400 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns; 6401 int n_ns; 6402 }; 6403 6404 /** 6405 * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args 6406 * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call 6407 * to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() 6408 * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each 6409 * call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after 6410 * ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to 6411 * the beginning of the actual data portion 6412 * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience 6413 * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition 6414 * (or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown) 6415 * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default 6416 * radiotap namespace or not 6417 * 6418 * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through 6419 * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering 6420 * @_arg_index: next argument index 6421 * @_arg: next argument pointer 6422 * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32 6423 * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present 6424 * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions 6425 * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data 6426 * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the 6427 * next bitmap word 6428 * 6429 * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore 6430 * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally. 6431 */ 6432 6433 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator { 6434 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader; 6435 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns; 6436 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace; 6437 6438 unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data; 6439 __le32 *_next_bitmap; 6440 6441 unsigned char *this_arg; 6442 int this_arg_index; 6443 int this_arg_size; 6444 6445 int is_radiotap_ns; 6446 6447 int _max_length; 6448 int _arg_index; 6449 uint32_t _bitmap_shifter; 6450 int _reset_on_ext; 6451 }; 6452 6453 int 6454 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator, 6455 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header, 6456 int max_length, 6457 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns); 6458 6459 int 6460 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator); 6461 6462 6463 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6]; 6464 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6]; 6465 6466 /** 6467 * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data 6468 * 6469 * @skb: the frame 6470 * 6471 * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function 6472 * returns the 802.11 header length. 6473 * 6474 * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption 6475 * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid 6476 * 802.11 header. 6477 */ 6478 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb); 6479 6480 /** 6481 * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control 6482 * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format 6483 * Return: The header length in bytes. 6484 */ 6485 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc); 6486 6487 /** 6488 * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length 6489 * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field 6490 * (first byte) will be accessed 6491 * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at 6492 * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present. 6493 */ 6494 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr); 6495 6496 /** 6497 * DOC: Data path helpers 6498 * 6499 * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers 6500 * functions that help implement the data path for devices 6501 * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device. 6502 */ 6503 6504 /** 6505 * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 6506 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 6507 * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead 6508 * of it being pushed into the SKB 6509 * @addr: the device MAC address 6510 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 6511 * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header 6512 * @is_amsdu: true if the 802.11 header is A-MSDU 6513 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 6514 */ 6515 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr, 6516 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 6517 u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu); 6518 6519 /** 6520 * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 6521 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 6522 * @addr: the device MAC address 6523 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 6524 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 6525 */ 6526 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr, 6527 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 6528 { 6529 return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false); 6530 } 6531 6532 /** 6533 * ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu - check if subframe lengths of an A-MSDU are valid 6534 * 6535 * This is used to detect non-standard A-MSDU frames, e.g. the ones generated 6536 * by ath10k and ath11k, where the subframe length includes the length of the 6537 * mesh control field. 6538 * 6539 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers. 6540 * @mesh_hdr: the type of mesh header to test 6541 * 0: non-mesh A-MSDU length field 6542 * 1: big-endian mesh A-MSDU length field 6543 * 2: little-endian mesh A-MSDU length field 6544 * Returns: true if subframe header lengths are valid for the @mesh_hdr mode 6545 */ 6546 bool ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 mesh_hdr); 6547 6548 /** 6549 * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame 6550 * 6551 * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames. 6552 * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully 6553 * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function. 6554 * 6555 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers. 6556 * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and 6557 * initialized by the caller. 6558 * @addr: The device MAC address. 6559 * @iftype: The device interface type. 6560 * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list. 6561 * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 6562 * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 6563 * @mesh_control: see mesh_hdr in ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu 6564 */ 6565 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list, 6566 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 6567 const unsigned int extra_headroom, 6568 const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa, 6569 u8 mesh_control); 6570 6571 /** 6572 * ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto - get RFC1042 or bridge tunnel encap protocol 6573 * 6574 * Check for RFC1042 or bridge tunnel header and fetch the encapsulated 6575 * protocol. 6576 * 6577 * @hdr: pointer to the MSDU payload 6578 * @proto: destination pointer to store the protocol 6579 * Return: true if encapsulation was found 6580 */ 6581 bool ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto(const void *hdr, __be16 *proto); 6582 6583 /** 6584 * ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr - strip mesh header from converted 802.3 frames 6585 * 6586 * Strip the mesh header, which was left in by ieee80211_data_to_8023 as part 6587 * of the MSDU data. Also move any source/destination addresses from the mesh 6588 * header to the ethernet header (if present). 6589 * 6590 * @skb: The 802.3 frame with embedded mesh header 6591 */ 6592 int ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr(struct sk_buff *skb); 6593 6594 /** 6595 * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame 6596 * @skb: the data frame 6597 * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use 6598 * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag. 6599 */ 6600 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb, 6601 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 6602 6603 /** 6604 * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data 6605 * 6606 * @eid: element ID 6607 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6608 * @len: length of data 6609 * @match: byte array to match 6610 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 6611 * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match. 6612 * Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers 6613 * the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take 6614 * the data portion instead. 6615 * 6616 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 6617 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6618 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 6619 * requested element struct. 6620 * 6621 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6622 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 6623 * byte array to match. 6624 */ 6625 const struct element * 6626 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 6627 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 6628 unsigned int match_offset); 6629 6630 /** 6631 * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data 6632 * 6633 * @eid: element ID 6634 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6635 * @len: length of data 6636 * @match: byte array to match 6637 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 6638 * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match. 6639 * If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero. 6640 * Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first 6641 * byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and 6642 * the second byte is the IE length. 6643 * 6644 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 6645 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6646 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first 6647 * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 6648 * element ID. 6649 * 6650 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6651 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 6652 * byte array to match. 6653 */ 6654 static inline const u8 * 6655 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 6656 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 6657 unsigned int match_offset) 6658 { 6659 /* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is 6660 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well. 6661 */ 6662 if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) || 6663 (!match_len && match_offset))) 6664 return NULL; 6665 6666 return (const void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, 6667 match, match_len, 6668 match_offset ? 6669 match_offset - 2 : 0); 6670 } 6671 6672 /** 6673 * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data 6674 * 6675 * @eid: element ID 6676 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6677 * @len: length of data 6678 * 6679 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 6680 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6681 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 6682 * requested element struct. 6683 * 6684 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6685 * having to fit into the given data. 6686 */ 6687 static inline const struct element * 6688 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 6689 { 6690 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 6691 } 6692 6693 /** 6694 * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data 6695 * 6696 * @eid: element ID 6697 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6698 * @len: length of data 6699 * 6700 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 6701 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6702 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 6703 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 6704 * 6705 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6706 * having to fit into the given data. 6707 */ 6708 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 6709 { 6710 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 6711 } 6712 6713 /** 6714 * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data 6715 * 6716 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 6717 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6718 * @len: length of data 6719 * 6720 * Return: %NULL if the extended element could not be found or if 6721 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6722 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 6723 * requested element struct. 6724 * 6725 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6726 * having to fit into the given data. 6727 */ 6728 static inline const struct element * 6729 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 6730 { 6731 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 6732 &ext_eid, 1, 0); 6733 } 6734 6735 /** 6736 * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data 6737 * 6738 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 6739 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6740 * @len: length of data 6741 * 6742 * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if 6743 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6744 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 6745 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 6746 * 6747 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6748 * having to fit into the given data. 6749 */ 6750 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 6751 { 6752 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 6753 &ext_eid, 1, 2); 6754 } 6755 6756 /** 6757 * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data 6758 * 6759 * @oui: vendor OUI 6760 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 6761 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6762 * @len: length of data 6763 * 6764 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 6765 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise 6766 * return the element structure for the requested element. 6767 * 6768 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 6769 * the given data. 6770 */ 6771 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 6772 const u8 *ies, 6773 unsigned int len); 6774 6775 /** 6776 * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data 6777 * 6778 * @oui: vendor OUI 6779 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 6780 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6781 * @len: length of data 6782 * 6783 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 6784 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to 6785 * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 6786 * element ID. 6787 * 6788 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 6789 * the given data. 6790 */ 6791 static inline const u8 * 6792 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 6793 const u8 *ies, unsigned int len) 6794 { 6795 return (const void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len); 6796 } 6797 6798 /** 6799 * cfg80211_defragment_element - Defrag the given element data into a buffer 6800 * 6801 * @elem: the element to defragment 6802 * @ies: elements where @elem is contained 6803 * @ieslen: length of @ies 6804 * @data: buffer to store element data 6805 * @data_len: length of @data 6806 * @frag_id: the element ID of fragments 6807 * 6808 * Return: length of @data, or -EINVAL on error 6809 * 6810 * Copy out all data from an element that may be fragmented into @data, while 6811 * skipping all headers. 6812 * 6813 * The function uses memmove() internally. It is acceptable to defragment an 6814 * element in-place. 6815 */ 6816 ssize_t cfg80211_defragment_element(const struct element *elem, const u8 *ies, 6817 size_t ieslen, u8 *data, size_t data_len, 6818 u8 frag_id); 6819 6820 /** 6821 * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame 6822 * 6823 * @dev: network device 6824 * @addr: STA MAC address 6825 * 6826 * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge 6827 * devices upon STA association. 6828 */ 6829 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 6830 6831 /** 6832 * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure 6833 * 6834 * TODO 6835 */ 6836 6837 /** 6838 * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain 6839 * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting 6840 * conflicts) 6841 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain 6842 * should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you 6843 * set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted 6844 * alpha2. 6845 * 6846 * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core 6847 * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by 6848 * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory 6849 * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain. 6850 * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried 6851 * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country. 6852 * 6853 * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call. 6854 * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(), 6855 * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw(). 6856 * 6857 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 6858 * an -ENOMEM. 6859 * 6860 * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM. 6861 */ 6862 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2); 6863 6864 /** 6865 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers 6866 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 6867 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy 6868 * 6869 * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they 6870 * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more 6871 * information. 6872 * 6873 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 6874 */ 6875 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6876 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 6877 6878 /** 6879 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers 6880 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 6881 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy 6882 * 6883 * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and 6884 * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details 6885 * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(). 6886 * 6887 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 6888 */ 6889 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6890 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 6891 6892 /** 6893 * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain 6894 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 6895 * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy 6896 * 6897 * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply 6898 * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory 6899 * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The 6900 * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous 6901 * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a 6902 * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled. 6903 * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag 6904 * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy 6905 * that called this helper. 6906 */ 6907 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6908 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd); 6909 6910 /** 6911 * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency 6912 * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for 6913 * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for 6914 * 6915 * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on 6916 * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain 6917 * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received 6918 * and processed already. 6919 * 6920 * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule 6921 * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to 6922 * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return 6923 * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even 6924 * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band. 6925 * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is 6926 * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific. 6927 */ 6928 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6929 u32 center_freq); 6930 6931 /** 6932 * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name 6933 * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator 6934 * 6935 * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a 6936 * proper string representation. 6937 */ 6938 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator); 6939 6940 /** 6941 * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom 6942 * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked. 6943 * 6944 * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI). 6945 */ 6946 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6947 6948 /** 6949 * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions 6950 * 6951 */ 6952 6953 /** 6954 * reg_query_regdb_wmm - Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule 6955 * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively 6956 * 6957 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried. 6958 * @freq: the frequency (in MHz) to be queried. 6959 * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db. 6960 * 6961 * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to query 6962 * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given 6963 * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations. 6964 * 6965 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 6966 * an -ENODATA. 6967 * 6968 * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA. 6969 */ 6970 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq, 6971 struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule); 6972 6973 /* 6974 * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification 6975 * functions and BSS handling helpers 6976 */ 6977 6978 /** 6979 * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished 6980 * 6981 * @request: the corresponding scan request 6982 * @info: information about the completed scan 6983 */ 6984 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request, 6985 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info); 6986 6987 /** 6988 * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available 6989 * 6990 * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results 6991 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6992 */ 6993 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6994 6995 /** 6996 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 6997 * 6998 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 6999 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 7000 * 7001 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 7002 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 7003 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 7004 */ 7005 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 7006 7007 /** 7008 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 7009 * 7010 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 7011 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 7012 * 7013 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 7014 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 7015 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 7016 * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held. 7017 */ 7018 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 7019 7020 /** 7021 * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame 7022 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 7023 * @data: the BSS metadata 7024 * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon) 7025 * @len: length of the management frame 7026 * @gfp: context flags 7027 * 7028 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 7029 * the BSS should be updated/added. 7030 * 7031 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 7032 * Or %NULL on error. 7033 */ 7034 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 7035 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7036 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 7037 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 7038 gfp_t gfp); 7039 7040 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 7041 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7042 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 7043 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 7044 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 7045 { 7046 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 7047 .chan = rx_channel, 7048 .signal = signal, 7049 }; 7050 7051 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); 7052 } 7053 7054 /** 7055 * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID 7056 * @bssid: transmitter BSSID 7057 * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element 7058 * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element 7059 * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID 7060 */ 7061 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid, 7062 u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid) 7063 { 7064 u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid); 7065 u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0); 7066 u64 new_bssid_u64; 7067 7068 new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask; 7069 7070 new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask; 7071 7072 u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid); 7073 } 7074 7075 /** 7076 * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited 7077 * @element: element to check 7078 * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element 7079 */ 7080 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element, 7081 const struct element *non_inherit_element); 7082 7083 /** 7084 * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs 7085 * @ie: ies 7086 * @ielen: length of IEs 7087 * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element 7088 * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile) 7089 * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile 7090 * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length 7091 */ 7092 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 7093 const struct element *mbssid_elem, 7094 const struct element *sub_elem, 7095 u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len); 7096 7097 /** 7098 * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from 7099 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is 7100 * from a beacon or probe response 7101 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon 7102 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response 7103 */ 7104 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type { 7105 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN, 7106 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON, 7107 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP, 7108 }; 7109 7110 /** 7111 * cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number - returns the channel number from ies 7112 * @ie: IEs 7113 * @ielen: length of IEs 7114 * @band: enum nl80211_band of the channel 7115 * 7116 * Returns the channel number, or -1 if none could be determined. 7117 */ 7118 int cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 7119 enum nl80211_band band); 7120 7121 /** 7122 * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS 7123 * 7124 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 7125 * @data: the BSS metadata 7126 * @ftype: frame type (if known) 7127 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS 7128 * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0) 7129 * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer 7130 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer 7131 * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer 7132 * @ielen: length of the additional IEs 7133 * @gfp: context flags 7134 * 7135 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 7136 * the BSS should be updated/added. 7137 * 7138 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 7139 * Or %NULL on error. 7140 */ 7141 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 7142 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7143 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 7144 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 7145 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 7146 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 7147 gfp_t gfp); 7148 7149 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 7150 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7151 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 7152 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 7153 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 7154 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 7155 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 7156 { 7157 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 7158 .chan = rx_channel, 7159 .signal = signal, 7160 }; 7161 7162 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, 7163 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, 7164 gfp); 7165 } 7166 7167 /** 7168 * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference 7169 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 7170 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL) 7171 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL) 7172 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL) 7173 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0) 7174 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type 7175 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy 7176 */ 7177 struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7178 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 7179 const u8 *bssid, 7180 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, 7181 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type, 7182 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy); 7183 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * 7184 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7185 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 7186 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len) 7187 { 7188 return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len, 7189 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 7190 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY); 7191 } 7192 7193 /** 7194 * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct 7195 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 7196 * @bss: the BSS struct to reference 7197 * 7198 * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct. 7199 */ 7200 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 7201 7202 /** 7203 * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct 7204 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 7205 * @bss: the BSS struct 7206 * 7207 * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct. 7208 */ 7209 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 7210 7211 /** 7212 * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures 7213 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7214 * @bss: the bss to remove 7215 * 7216 * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures 7217 * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this 7218 * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time 7219 * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all. 7220 */ 7221 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 7222 7223 /** 7224 * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries 7225 * 7226 * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy 7227 * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not 7228 * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB. 7229 * 7230 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7231 * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel 7232 * of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel. 7233 * @iter: the iterator function to call 7234 * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function 7235 */ 7236 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7237 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7238 void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7239 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 7240 void *data), 7241 void *iter_data); 7242 7243 /** 7244 * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame 7245 * @dev: network device 7246 * @buf: authentication frame (header + body) 7247 * @len: length of the frame data 7248 * 7249 * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or 7250 * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode. 7251 * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must 7252 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 7253 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 7254 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 7255 * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed 7256 * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used 7257 * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function 7258 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead. 7259 * 7260 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 7261 */ 7262 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 7263 7264 /** 7265 * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication 7266 * @dev: network device 7267 * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out 7268 * 7269 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's 7270 * mutex. 7271 */ 7272 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 7273 7274 /** 7275 * struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data - association response data 7276 * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer 7277 * moves to cfg80211 in the call to cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp() 7278 * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body) 7279 * @len: length of the frame data 7280 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format 7281 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 7282 * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame 7283 * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data 7284 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address (in case of MLO) 7285 * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID, use links[0] for 7286 * non-MLO connections 7287 * @links.status: Set this (along with a BSS pointer) for links that 7288 * were rejected by the AP. 7289 */ 7290 struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data { 7291 const u8 *buf; 7292 size_t len; 7293 const u8 *req_ies; 7294 size_t req_ies_len; 7295 int uapsd_queues; 7296 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 7297 struct { 7298 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 7299 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 7300 u16 status; 7301 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 7302 }; 7303 7304 /** 7305 * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response 7306 * @dev: network device 7307 * @data: association response data, &struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data 7308 * 7309 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 7310 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 7311 * 7312 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 7313 */ 7314 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev, 7315 struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data *data); 7316 7317 /** 7318 * struct cfg80211_assoc_failure - association failure data 7319 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address, or %NULL 7320 * @bss: list of BSSes, must use entry 0 for non-MLO connections 7321 * (@ap_mld_addr is %NULL) 7322 * @timeout: indicates the association failed due to timeout, otherwise 7323 * the association was abandoned for a reason reported through some 7324 * other API (e.g. deauth RX) 7325 */ 7326 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure { 7327 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 7328 struct cfg80211_bss *bss[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 7329 bool timeout; 7330 }; 7331 7332 /** 7333 * cfg80211_assoc_failure - notification of association failure 7334 * @dev: network device 7335 * @data: data describing the association failure 7336 * 7337 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 7338 */ 7339 void cfg80211_assoc_failure(struct net_device *dev, 7340 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure *data); 7341 7342 /** 7343 * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame 7344 * @dev: network device 7345 * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body) 7346 * @len: length of the frame data 7347 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute) 7348 * 7349 * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in 7350 * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and 7351 * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the 7352 * corresponding wdev's mutex. 7353 */ 7354 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 7355 bool reconnect); 7356 7357 /** 7358 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame 7359 * @dev: network device 7360 * @buf: received management frame (header + body) 7361 * @len: length of the frame data 7362 * 7363 * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc 7364 * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the 7365 * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon 7366 * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while 7367 * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode). 7368 * 7369 * This function may sleep. 7370 */ 7371 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, 7372 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 7373 7374 /** 7375 * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP) 7376 * @dev: network device 7377 * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame 7378 * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used 7379 * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing. 7380 * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets) 7381 * @gfp: allocation flags 7382 * 7383 * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a 7384 * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() 7385 * primitive. 7386 */ 7387 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 7388 enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id, 7389 const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp); 7390 7391 /** 7392 * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS 7393 * 7394 * @dev: network device 7395 * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined 7396 * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined 7397 * @gfp: allocation flags 7398 * 7399 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or 7400 * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called, 7401 * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of 7402 * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called 7403 * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is 7404 * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest. 7405 */ 7406 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7407 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp); 7408 7409 /** 7410 * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer 7411 * candidate 7412 * 7413 * @dev: network device 7414 * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate 7415 * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate 7416 * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer 7417 * @sig_dbm: signal level in dBm 7418 * @gfp: allocation flags 7419 * 7420 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been 7421 * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response. 7422 * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace. 7423 */ 7424 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev, 7425 const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len, 7426 int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp); 7427 7428 /** 7429 * DOC: RFkill integration 7430 * 7431 * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers, 7432 * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each 7433 * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated 7434 * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are 7435 * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down. 7436 * 7437 * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they 7438 * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211. 7439 * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here. 7440 */ 7441 7442 /** 7443 * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state 7444 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7445 * @blocked: block status 7446 * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons 7447 */ 7448 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked, 7449 enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason); 7450 7451 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked) 7452 { 7453 wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked, 7454 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL); 7455 } 7456 7457 /** 7458 * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill 7459 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7460 */ 7461 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7462 7463 /** 7464 * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill 7465 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7466 */ 7467 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy) 7468 { 7469 rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill); 7470 } 7471 7472 /** 7473 * DOC: Vendor commands 7474 * 7475 * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that 7476 * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the 7477 * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with 7478 * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as 7479 * the configuration mechanism. 7480 * 7481 * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array 7482 * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an 7483 * OUI and sub command ID to identify it. 7484 * 7485 * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol 7486 * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular, 7487 * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any 7488 * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection 7489 * managers etc. need. 7490 */ 7491 7492 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7493 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 7494 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 7495 int approxlen); 7496 7497 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7498 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7499 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 7500 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 7501 unsigned int portid, 7502 int vendor_event_idx, 7503 int approxlen, gfp_t gfp); 7504 7505 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp); 7506 7507 /** 7508 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply 7509 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7510 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 7511 * be put into the skb 7512 * 7513 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 7514 * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 7515 * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid. 7516 * 7517 * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in 7518 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 7519 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 7520 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 7521 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 7522 * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute. 7523 * You must not modify the skb in any other way. 7524 * 7525 * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return 7526 * its error code as the result of the doit() operation. 7527 * 7528 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 7529 */ 7530 static inline struct sk_buff * 7531 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 7532 { 7533 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 7534 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen); 7535 } 7536 7537 /** 7538 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb 7539 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 7540 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb() 7541 * 7542 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 7543 * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should 7544 * return the error code. Note that this function consumes the 7545 * skb regardless of the return value. 7546 * 7547 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 7548 */ 7549 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb); 7550 7551 /** 7552 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID 7553 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7554 * 7555 * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler. 7556 * Valid to call only there. 7557 */ 7558 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7559 7560 /** 7561 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb 7562 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7563 * @wdev: the wireless device 7564 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 7565 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 7566 * be put into the skb 7567 * @gfp: allocation flags 7568 * 7569 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 7570 * vendor-specific multicast group. 7571 * 7572 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 7573 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 7574 * attribute. 7575 * 7576 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 7577 * skb to send the event. 7578 * 7579 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 7580 */ 7581 static inline struct sk_buff * 7582 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7583 int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 7584 { 7585 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 7586 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 7587 0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 7588 } 7589 7590 /** 7591 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb 7592 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7593 * @wdev: the wireless device 7594 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 7595 * @portid: port ID of the receiver 7596 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 7597 * be put into the skb 7598 * @gfp: allocation flags 7599 * 7600 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to 7601 * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been 7602 * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take 7603 * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes. 7604 * 7605 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 7606 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 7607 * attribute. 7608 * 7609 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 7610 * skb to send the event. 7611 * 7612 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 7613 */ 7614 static inline struct sk_buff * 7615 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7616 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7617 unsigned int portid, int approxlen, 7618 int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 7619 { 7620 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 7621 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 7622 portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 7623 } 7624 7625 /** 7626 * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event 7627 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc() 7628 * @gfp: allocation flags 7629 * 7630 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 7631 * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it. 7632 */ 7633 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 7634 { 7635 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 7636 } 7637 7638 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 7639 /** 7640 * DOC: Test mode 7641 * 7642 * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to 7643 * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance, 7644 * factory programming. 7645 * 7646 * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more 7647 * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it. 7648 */ 7649 7650 /** 7651 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply 7652 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7653 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 7654 * be put into the skb 7655 * 7656 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 7657 * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 7658 * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid. 7659 * 7660 * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in 7661 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 7662 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 7663 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 7664 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 7665 * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You 7666 * must not modify the skb in any other way. 7667 * 7668 * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return 7669 * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation. 7670 * 7671 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 7672 */ 7673 static inline struct sk_buff * 7674 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 7675 { 7676 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 7677 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen); 7678 } 7679 7680 /** 7681 * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb 7682 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 7683 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() 7684 * 7685 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 7686 * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return 7687 * the error code. Note that this function consumes the skb 7688 * regardless of the return value. 7689 * 7690 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 7691 */ 7692 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb) 7693 { 7694 return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb); 7695 } 7696 7697 /** 7698 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event 7699 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7700 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 7701 * be put into the skb 7702 * @gfp: allocation flags 7703 * 7704 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 7705 * testmode multicast group. 7706 * 7707 * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with 7708 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As 7709 * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the 7710 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb 7711 * in any other way. 7712 * 7713 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the 7714 * skb to send the event. 7715 * 7716 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 7717 */ 7718 static inline struct sk_buff * 7719 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp) 7720 { 7721 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 7722 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1, 7723 approxlen, gfp); 7724 } 7725 7726 /** 7727 * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event 7728 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 7729 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb() 7730 * @gfp: allocation flags 7731 * 7732 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 7733 * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always 7734 * consumes it. 7735 */ 7736 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 7737 { 7738 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 7739 } 7740 7741 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) .testmode_cmd = (cmd), 7742 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) .testmode_dump = (cmd), 7743 #else 7744 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) 7745 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) 7746 #endif 7747 7748 /** 7749 * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params 7750 * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL) 7751 * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets 7752 * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in 7753 * @erp_next_seq_num is valid. 7754 * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in 7755 * FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the 7756 * status for a FILS connection. 7757 * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL). 7758 * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets 7759 * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID 7760 * used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL). 7761 */ 7762 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params { 7763 const u8 *kek; 7764 size_t kek_len; 7765 bool update_erp_next_seq_num; 7766 u16 erp_next_seq_num; 7767 const u8 *pmk; 7768 size_t pmk_len; 7769 const u8 *pmkid; 7770 }; 7771 7772 /** 7773 * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params 7774 * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 7775 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 7776 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 7777 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 7778 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 7779 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 7780 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 7781 * case. 7782 * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL) 7783 * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length 7784 * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7785 * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length 7786 * @fils: FILS connection response parameters. 7787 * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 7788 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 7789 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 7790 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 7791 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 7792 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 7793 * @valid_links: For MLO connection, BIT mask of the valid link ids. Otherwise 7794 * zero. 7795 * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the AP. Otherwise %NULL. 7796 * @links : For MLO connection, contains link info for the valid links indicated 7797 * using @valid_links. For non-MLO connection, links[0] contains the 7798 * connected AP info. 7799 * @links.addr: For MLO connection, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise 7800 * %NULL. 7801 * @links.bssid: For MLO connection, MAC address of the AP link. For non-MLO 7802 * connection, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL). 7803 * @links.bss: For MLO connection, entry of bss to which STA link is connected. 7804 * For non-MLO connection, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to which STA 7805 * is connected. It can be obtained through cfg80211_get_bss() (may be 7806 * %NULL). It is recommended to store the bss from the connect_request and 7807 * hold a reference to it and return through this param to avoid a warning 7808 * if the bss is expired during the connection, esp. for those drivers 7809 * implementing connect op. Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs 7810 * to be specified. 7811 * @links.status: per-link status code, to report a status code that's not 7812 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for a given link, it must also be in the 7813 * @valid_links bitmap and may have a BSS pointer (which is then released) 7814 */ 7815 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params { 7816 int status; 7817 const u8 *req_ie; 7818 size_t req_ie_len; 7819 const u8 *resp_ie; 7820 size_t resp_ie_len; 7821 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 7822 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason; 7823 7824 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 7825 u16 valid_links; 7826 struct { 7827 const u8 *addr; 7828 const u8 *bssid; 7829 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 7830 u16 status; 7831 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 7832 }; 7833 7834 /** 7835 * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result 7836 * 7837 * @dev: network device 7838 * @params: connection response parameters 7839 * @gfp: allocation flags 7840 * 7841 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 7842 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 7843 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response 7844 * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), 7845 * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(), 7846 * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7847 */ 7848 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev, 7849 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params, 7850 gfp_t gfp); 7851 7852 /** 7853 * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result 7854 * 7855 * @dev: network device 7856 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7857 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through 7858 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the 7859 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return 7860 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the 7861 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op. 7862 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified. 7863 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7864 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7865 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7866 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 7867 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 7868 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 7869 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 7870 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 7871 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 7872 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 7873 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 7874 * case. 7875 * @gfp: allocation flags 7876 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 7877 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 7878 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 7879 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 7880 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 7881 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 7882 * 7883 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 7884 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 7885 * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss 7886 * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among 7887 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 7888 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7889 */ 7890 static inline void 7891 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7892 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie, 7893 size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie, 7894 size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp, 7895 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 7896 { 7897 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params; 7898 7899 memset(¶ms, 0, sizeof(params)); 7900 params.status = status; 7901 params.links[0].bssid = bssid; 7902 params.links[0].bss = bss; 7903 params.req_ie = req_ie; 7904 params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len; 7905 params.resp_ie = resp_ie; 7906 params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len; 7907 params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason; 7908 7909 cfg80211_connect_done(dev, ¶ms, gfp); 7910 } 7911 7912 /** 7913 * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result 7914 * 7915 * @dev: network device 7916 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7917 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7918 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7919 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7920 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 7921 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 7922 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 7923 * the real status code for failures. 7924 * @gfp: allocation flags 7925 * 7926 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 7927 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 7928 * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only 7929 * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 7930 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7931 */ 7932 static inline void 7933 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7934 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, 7935 const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len, 7936 u16 status, gfp_t gfp) 7937 { 7938 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie, 7939 resp_ie_len, status, gfp, 7940 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED); 7941 } 7942 7943 /** 7944 * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout 7945 * 7946 * @dev: network device 7947 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7948 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7949 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7950 * @gfp: allocation flags 7951 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. 7952 * 7953 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed 7954 * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was 7955 * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send 7956 * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while 7957 * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among 7958 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 7959 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7960 */ 7961 static inline void 7962 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7963 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp, 7964 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 7965 { 7966 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1, 7967 gfp, timeout_reason); 7968 } 7969 7970 /** 7971 * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information 7972 * 7973 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7974 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7975 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7976 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 7977 * @fils: FILS related roaming information. 7978 * @valid_links: For MLO roaming, BIT mask of the new valid links is set. 7979 * Otherwise zero. 7980 * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO roaming, MLD address of the new AP. Otherwise %NULL. 7981 * @links : For MLO roaming, contains new link info for the valid links set in 7982 * @valid_links. For non-MLO roaming, links[0] contains the new AP info. 7983 * @links.addr: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise %NULL. 7984 * @links.bssid: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the new AP link. For non-MLO 7985 * roaming, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the new AP. May be 7986 * %NULL if %links.bss is set. 7987 * @links.channel: the channel of the new AP. 7988 * @links.bss: For MLO roaming, entry of new bss to which STA link got 7989 * roamed. For non-MLO roaming, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to 7990 * which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %links.bssid is set) 7991 */ 7992 struct cfg80211_roam_info { 7993 const u8 *req_ie; 7994 size_t req_ie_len; 7995 const u8 *resp_ie; 7996 size_t resp_ie_len; 7997 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 7998 7999 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 8000 u16 valid_links; 8001 struct { 8002 const u8 *addr; 8003 const u8 *bssid; 8004 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 8005 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 8006 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 8007 }; 8008 8009 /** 8010 * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming 8011 * 8012 * @dev: network device 8013 * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info. 8014 * @gfp: allocation flags 8015 * 8016 * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the 8017 * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry. 8018 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP 8019 * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in 8020 * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where 8021 * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the 8022 * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling 8023 * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released 8024 * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be 8025 * released while disconnecting from the current bss. 8026 */ 8027 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info, 8028 gfp_t gfp); 8029 8030 /** 8031 * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association 8032 * 8033 * @dev: network device 8034 * @peer_addr: BSSID of the AP/P2P GO in case of STA/GC or STA/GC MAC address 8035 * in case of AP/P2P GO 8036 * @td_bitmap: transition disable policy 8037 * @td_bitmap_len: Length of transition disable policy 8038 * @gfp: allocation flags 8039 * 8040 * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake 8041 * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e., 8042 * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function 8043 * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(), 8044 * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to 8045 * indicate the 802.11 association. 8046 * This function can also be called by AP/P2P GO driver that supports 8047 * authentication offload. In this case the peer_mac passed is that of 8048 * associated STA/GC. 8049 */ 8050 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer_addr, 8051 const u8* td_bitmap, u8 td_bitmap_len, gfp_t gfp); 8052 8053 /** 8054 * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped 8055 * 8056 * @dev: network device 8057 * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL) 8058 * @ie_len: length of IEs 8059 * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown 8060 * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally 8061 * @gfp: allocation flags 8062 * 8063 * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state 8064 * and not try to connect to any AP any more. 8065 */ 8066 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason, 8067 const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len, 8068 bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp); 8069 8070 /** 8071 * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start 8072 * @wdev: wireless device 8073 * @cookie: the request cookie 8074 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 8075 * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the 8076 * channel 8077 * @gfp: allocation flags 8078 */ 8079 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 8080 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 8081 unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp); 8082 8083 /** 8084 * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired 8085 * @wdev: wireless device 8086 * @cookie: the request cookie 8087 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 8088 * @gfp: allocation flags 8089 */ 8090 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 8091 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 8092 gfp_t gfp); 8093 8094 /** 8095 * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired 8096 * @wdev: wireless device 8097 * @cookie: the requested cookie 8098 * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request) 8099 * @gfp: allocation flags 8100 */ 8101 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 8102 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp); 8103 8104 /** 8105 * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics. 8106 * 8107 * @sinfo: the station information 8108 * @gfp: allocation flags 8109 */ 8110 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 8111 8112 /** 8113 * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info 8114 * @sinfo: the station information 8115 * 8116 * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station 8117 * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on 8118 * the stack.) 8119 */ 8120 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo) 8121 { 8122 kfree(sinfo->pertid); 8123 } 8124 8125 /** 8126 * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station 8127 * 8128 * @dev: the netdev 8129 * @mac_addr: the station's address 8130 * @sinfo: the station information 8131 * @gfp: allocation flags 8132 */ 8133 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 8134 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 8135 8136 /** 8137 * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station 8138 * @dev: the netdev 8139 * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used. 8140 * @sinfo: the station information/statistics 8141 * @gfp: allocation flags 8142 */ 8143 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 8144 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 8145 8146 /** 8147 * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station 8148 * 8149 * @dev: the netdev 8150 * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used. 8151 * @gfp: allocation flags 8152 */ 8153 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev, 8154 const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp) 8155 { 8156 cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp); 8157 } 8158 8159 /** 8160 * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification 8161 * 8162 * @dev: the netdev 8163 * @mac_addr: the station's address 8164 * @reason: the reason for connection failure 8165 * @gfp: allocation flags 8166 * 8167 * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station 8168 * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection 8169 * for some reasons, this function is called. 8170 * 8171 * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from 8172 * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum 8173 */ 8174 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 8175 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason, 8176 gfp_t gfp); 8177 8178 /** 8179 * struct cfg80211_rx_info - received management frame info 8180 * 8181 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in kHz 8182 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 8183 * @have_link_id: indicates the frame was received on a link of 8184 * an MLD, i.e. the @link_id field is valid 8185 * @link_id: the ID of the link the frame was received on 8186 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 8187 * @len: length of the frame data 8188 * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 8189 * @rx_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of frame RX in nanoseconds 8190 * @ack_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of ack TX in nanoseconds 8191 */ 8192 struct cfg80211_rx_info { 8193 int freq; 8194 int sig_dbm; 8195 bool have_link_id; 8196 u8 link_id; 8197 const u8 *buf; 8198 size_t len; 8199 u32 flags; 8200 u64 rx_tstamp; 8201 u64 ack_tstamp; 8202 }; 8203 8204 /** 8205 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext - management frame notification with extended info 8206 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8207 * @info: RX info as defined in struct cfg80211_rx_info 8208 * 8209 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 8210 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 8211 * 8212 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 8213 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 8214 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 8215 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 8216 */ 8217 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8218 struct cfg80211_rx_info *info); 8219 8220 /** 8221 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 8222 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8223 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz 8224 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 8225 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 8226 * @len: length of the frame data 8227 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 8228 * 8229 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 8230 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 8231 * 8232 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 8233 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 8234 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 8235 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 8236 */ 8237 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, 8238 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 8239 u32 flags) 8240 { 8241 struct cfg80211_rx_info info = { 8242 .freq = freq, 8243 .sig_dbm = sig_dbm, 8244 .buf = buf, 8245 .len = len, 8246 .flags = flags 8247 }; 8248 8249 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info); 8250 } 8251 8252 /** 8253 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 8254 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8255 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz 8256 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 8257 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 8258 * @len: length of the frame data 8259 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 8260 * 8261 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 8262 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 8263 * 8264 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 8265 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 8266 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 8267 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 8268 */ 8269 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, 8270 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 8271 u32 flags) 8272 { 8273 struct cfg80211_rx_info info = { 8274 .freq = MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), 8275 .sig_dbm = sig_dbm, 8276 .buf = buf, 8277 .len = len, 8278 .flags = flags 8279 }; 8280 8281 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info); 8282 } 8283 8284 /** 8285 * struct cfg80211_tx_status - TX status for management frame information 8286 * 8287 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() 8288 * @tx_tstamp: hardware TX timestamp in nanoseconds 8289 * @ack_tstamp: hardware ack RX timestamp in nanoseconds 8290 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 8291 * @len: length of the frame data 8292 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 8293 */ 8294 struct cfg80211_tx_status { 8295 u64 cookie; 8296 u64 tx_tstamp; 8297 u64 ack_tstamp; 8298 const u8 *buf; 8299 size_t len; 8300 bool ack; 8301 }; 8302 8303 /** 8304 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext - TX status notification with extended info 8305 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8306 * @status: TX status data 8307 * @gfp: context flags 8308 * 8309 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be 8310 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the 8311 * transmission attempt with extended info. 8312 */ 8313 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8314 struct cfg80211_tx_status *status, gfp_t gfp); 8315 8316 /** 8317 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame 8318 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8319 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() 8320 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 8321 * @len: length of the frame data 8322 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 8323 * @gfp: context flags 8324 * 8325 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be 8326 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the 8327 * transmission attempt. 8328 */ 8329 static inline void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8330 u64 cookie, const u8 *buf, 8331 size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp) 8332 { 8333 struct cfg80211_tx_status status = { 8334 .cookie = cookie, 8335 .buf = buf, 8336 .len = len, 8337 .ack = ack 8338 }; 8339 8340 cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(wdev, &status, gfp); 8341 } 8342 8343 /** 8344 * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control 8345 * port frames 8346 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8347 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() 8348 * @buf: Data frame (header + body) 8349 * @len: length of the frame data 8350 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 8351 * @gfp: context flags 8352 * 8353 * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be 8354 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of 8355 * the transmission attempt. 8356 */ 8357 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 8358 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, 8359 gfp_t gfp); 8360 8361 /** 8362 * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame 8363 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 8364 * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame. It is assumed that the skbuf 8365 * is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header). The skb can be non-linear. 8366 * This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is 8367 * responsible for any cleanup. The caller must also ensure that 8368 * skb->protocol is set appropriately. 8369 * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted 8370 * @link_id: the link the frame was received on, -1 if not applicable or unknown 8371 * 8372 * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port 8373 * frame. It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive 8374 * control port frames over nl80211. 8375 * 8376 * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all 8377 * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame). 8378 * 8379 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace 8380 */ 8381 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, struct sk_buff *skb, 8382 bool unencrypted, int link_id); 8383 8384 /** 8385 * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event 8386 * @dev: network device 8387 * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event 8388 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available 8389 * @gfp: context flags 8390 * 8391 * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring 8392 * rssi threshold reached event occurs. 8393 */ 8394 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev, 8395 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, 8396 s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp); 8397 8398 /** 8399 * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer 8400 * @dev: network device 8401 * @peer: peer's MAC address 8402 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold 8403 * but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent 8404 * threshold (to account for temporary interference) 8405 * @gfp: context flags 8406 */ 8407 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev, 8408 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp); 8409 8410 /** 8411 * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event 8412 * @dev: network device 8413 * @peer: peer's MAC address 8414 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost 8415 * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission 8416 * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached. 8417 * @gfp: context flags 8418 * 8419 * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a 8420 * given interval is exceeded. 8421 */ 8422 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 8423 u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp); 8424 8425 /** 8426 * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event 8427 * @dev: network device 8428 * @gfp: context flags 8429 * 8430 * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP. 8431 */ 8432 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp); 8433 8434 /** 8435 * __cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event 8436 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8437 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 8438 * @offchan: the radar has been detected on the offchannel chain 8439 * @gfp: context flags 8440 * 8441 * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl. 8442 */ 8443 void __cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8444 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8445 bool offchan, gfp_t gfp); 8446 8447 static inline void 8448 cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8449 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8450 gfp_t gfp) 8451 { 8452 __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, false, gfp); 8453 } 8454 8455 static inline void 8456 cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8457 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8458 gfp_t gfp) 8459 { 8460 __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, true, gfp); 8461 } 8462 8463 /** 8464 * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event 8465 * @dev: network device 8466 * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified 8467 * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value 8468 * @gfp: context flags 8469 * 8470 * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action 8471 * frame. 8472 */ 8473 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac, 8474 struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode, 8475 gfp_t gfp); 8476 8477 /** 8478 * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event 8479 * @netdev: network device 8480 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 8481 * @event: type of event 8482 * @gfp: context flags 8483 * 8484 * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished 8485 * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process, 8486 * also by full-MAC drivers. 8487 */ 8488 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev, 8489 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8490 enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp); 8491 8492 /** 8493 * cfg80211_background_cac_abort - Channel Availability Check offchan abort event 8494 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8495 * 8496 * This function is called by the driver when a Channel Availability Check 8497 * (CAC) is aborted by a offchannel dedicated chain. 8498 */ 8499 void cfg80211_background_cac_abort(struct wiphy *wiphy); 8500 8501 /** 8502 * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying 8503 * @dev: network device 8504 * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races) 8505 * @replay_ctr: new replay counter 8506 * @gfp: allocation flags 8507 */ 8508 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 8509 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); 8510 8511 /** 8512 * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate 8513 * @dev: network device 8514 * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority) 8515 * @bssid: BSSID of AP 8516 * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication 8517 * @gfp: allocation flags 8518 */ 8519 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index, 8520 const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp); 8521 8522 /** 8523 * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame 8524 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 8525 * @addr: the transmitter address 8526 * @gfp: context flags 8527 * 8528 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 8529 * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the 8530 * sender. 8531 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 8532 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 8533 */ 8534 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev, 8535 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 8536 8537 /** 8538 * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame 8539 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 8540 * @addr: the transmitter address 8541 * @gfp: context flags 8542 * 8543 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 8544 * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected. 8545 * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each 8546 * station to avoid event flooding. 8547 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 8548 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 8549 */ 8550 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev, 8551 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 8552 8553 /** 8554 * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status 8555 * @dev: the device the probe was sent on 8556 * @addr: the address of the peer 8557 * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously 8558 * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not 8559 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame. 8560 * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not. 8561 * @gfp: allocation flags 8562 */ 8563 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 8564 u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal, 8565 bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp); 8566 8567 /** 8568 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs 8569 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 8570 * @frame: the frame 8571 * @len: length of the frame 8572 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz 8573 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 8574 * 8575 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 8576 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 8577 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 8578 */ 8579 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame, 8580 size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm); 8581 8582 /** 8583 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs 8584 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 8585 * @frame: the frame 8586 * @len: length of the frame 8587 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on 8588 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 8589 * 8590 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 8591 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 8592 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 8593 */ 8594 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8595 const u8 *frame, size_t len, 8596 int freq, int sig_dbm) 8597 { 8598 cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), 8599 sig_dbm); 8600 } 8601 8602 /** 8603 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed 8604 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8605 * @chandef: the channel definition 8606 * @iftype: interface type 8607 * 8608 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 8609 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.) 8610 */ 8611 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8612 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8613 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 8614 8615 /** 8616 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation 8617 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8618 * @chandef: the channel definition 8619 * @iftype: interface type 8620 * 8621 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 8622 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version 8623 * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under 8624 * more permissive conditions. 8625 * 8626 * Requires the wiphy mutex to be held. 8627 */ 8628 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8629 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8630 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 8631 8632 /* 8633 * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace 8634 * @dev: the device which switched channels 8635 * @chandef: the new channel definition 8636 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO 8637 * @punct_bitmap: the new puncturing bitmap 8638 * 8639 * Caller must hold wiphy mutex, therefore must only be called from sleepable 8640 * driver context! 8641 */ 8642 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev, 8643 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8644 unsigned int link_id, u16 punct_bitmap); 8645 8646 /* 8647 * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start 8648 * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started 8649 * @chandef: the future channel definition 8650 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO 8651 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens 8652 * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP 8653 * @punct_bitmap: the future puncturing bitmap 8654 * 8655 * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just 8656 * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting 8657 * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary. 8658 */ 8659 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev, 8660 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8661 unsigned int link_id, u8 count, 8662 bool quiet, u16 punct_bitmap); 8663 8664 /** 8665 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band 8666 * 8667 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert 8668 * @band: band pointer to fill 8669 * 8670 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 8671 */ 8672 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class, 8673 enum nl80211_band *band); 8674 8675 /** 8676 * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class 8677 * 8678 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 8679 * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class 8680 * 8681 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 8682 */ 8683 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8684 u8 *op_class); 8685 8686 /** 8687 * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz 8688 * 8689 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 8690 * 8691 * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz. 8692 */ 8693 static inline u32 8694 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 8695 { 8696 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset; 8697 } 8698 8699 /* 8700 * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation 8701 * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested 8702 * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device 8703 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or 8704 * NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN) 8705 * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request 8706 * @gfp: allocation flags 8707 * 8708 * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that 8709 * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP 8710 * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use 8711 * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g., 8712 * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer). 8713 */ 8714 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 8715 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, 8716 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); 8717 8718 /* 8719 * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units) 8720 * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from 8721 * 8722 * return 0 if MCS index >= 32 8723 */ 8724 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate); 8725 8726 /** 8727 * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev 8728 * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove 8729 * 8730 * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary 8731 * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device 8732 * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called 8733 * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device 8734 * is unbound from the driver. 8735 * 8736 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 8737 */ 8738 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev); 8739 8740 /** 8741 * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev 8742 * @dev: the netdev to register 8743 * 8744 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather 8745 * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is 8746 * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable 8747 * instead as well. 8748 * 8749 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 8750 */ 8751 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev); 8752 8753 /** 8754 * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev 8755 * @dev: the netdev to register 8756 * 8757 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather 8758 * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL 8759 * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are 8760 * usable instead as well. 8761 * 8762 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 8763 */ 8764 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev) 8765 { 8766 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211) 8767 cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr); 8768 #endif 8769 } 8770 8771 /** 8772 * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements 8773 * @ies: FT IEs 8774 * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes 8775 * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address 8776 * @ric_ies: RIC IE 8777 * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes 8778 */ 8779 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params { 8780 const u8 *ies; 8781 size_t ies_len; 8782 const u8 *target_ap; 8783 const u8 *ric_ies; 8784 size_t ric_ies_len; 8785 }; 8786 8787 /** 8788 * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE 8789 * @netdev: network device 8790 * @ft_event: IE information 8791 */ 8792 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev, 8793 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event); 8794 8795 /** 8796 * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer 8797 * @ies: the input IE buffer 8798 * @len: the input length 8799 * @attr: the attribute ID to find 8800 * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g. 8801 * if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size 8802 * @bufsize: size of the output buffer 8803 * 8804 * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and 8805 * copies its contents to the given buffer. 8806 * 8807 * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is 8808 * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the 8809 * length of the found attribute (which can be zero). 8810 */ 8811 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 8812 enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr, 8813 u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize); 8814 8815 /** 8816 * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC) 8817 * @ies: the IE buffer 8818 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 8819 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 8820 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 8821 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 8822 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 8823 * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element 8824 * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array 8825 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 8826 * 8827 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 8828 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 8829 * split. 8830 * 8831 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 8832 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 8833 * 8834 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 8835 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 8836 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 8837 * 8838 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the 8839 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) 8840 * of the buffer should be used. 8841 */ 8842 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 8843 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, 8844 const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric, 8845 size_t offset); 8846 8847 /** 8848 * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering 8849 * @ies: the IE buffer 8850 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 8851 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 8852 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 8853 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 8854 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 8855 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 8856 * 8857 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 8858 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 8859 * split. 8860 * 8861 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 8862 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 8863 * 8864 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 8865 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 8866 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 8867 * 8868 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the 8869 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) 8870 * of the buffer should be used. 8871 */ 8872 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 8873 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset) 8874 { 8875 return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset); 8876 } 8877 8878 /** 8879 * ieee80211_fragment_element - fragment the last element in skb 8880 * @skb: The skbuf that the element was added to 8881 * @len_pos: Pointer to length of the element to fragment 8882 * @frag_id: The element ID to use for fragments 8883 * 8884 * This function fragments all data after @len_pos, adding fragmentation 8885 * elements with the given ID as appropriate. The SKB will grow in size 8886 * accordingly. 8887 */ 8888 void ieee80211_fragment_element(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *len_pos, u8 frag_id); 8889 8890 /** 8891 * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN 8892 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup 8893 * @wakeup: the wakeup report 8894 * @gfp: allocation flags 8895 * 8896 * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it 8897 * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may 8898 * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something 8899 * else caused the wakeup. 8900 */ 8901 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8902 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, 8903 gfp_t gfp); 8904 8905 /** 8906 * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver. 8907 * 8908 * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped. 8909 * @gfp: allocation flags 8910 * 8911 * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted 8912 * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given 8913 * by .crit_proto_start() has expired. 8914 */ 8915 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp); 8916 8917 /** 8918 * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has 8919 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8920 * 8921 * Return: the number of channels supported by the device. 8922 */ 8923 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy); 8924 8925 /** 8926 * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations 8927 * 8928 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8929 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 8930 * 8931 * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a 8932 * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to 8933 * the interface combinations. 8934 */ 8935 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8936 struct iface_combination_params *params); 8937 8938 /** 8939 * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations 8940 * 8941 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8942 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 8943 * @iter: function to call for each matching combination 8944 * @data: pointer to pass to iter function 8945 * 8946 * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible 8947 * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching 8948 * purposes. 8949 */ 8950 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8951 struct iface_combination_params *params, 8952 void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c, 8953 void *data), 8954 void *data); 8955 8956 /* 8957 * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection 8958 * 8959 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8960 * @wdev: wireless device 8961 * @gfp: context flags 8962 * 8963 * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA 8964 * disconnected. 8965 * 8966 * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous. 8967 */ 8968 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8969 gfp_t gfp); 8970 8971 /** 8972 * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy 8973 * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down 8974 * 8975 * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by 8976 * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed). 8977 * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors 8978 * that really can't be recovered in any other way. 8979 * 8980 * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into 8981 * the driver while the function is running. 8982 */ 8983 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy); 8984 8985 /** 8986 * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag 8987 * 8988 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 8989 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 8990 * 8991 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 8992 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 8993 */ 8994 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8995 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 8996 { 8997 u8 *ft_byte; 8998 8999 ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 9000 *ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8); 9001 } 9002 9003 /** 9004 * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag 9005 * 9006 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 9007 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 9008 * 9009 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 9010 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 9011 */ 9012 static inline bool 9013 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy, 9014 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 9015 { 9016 u8 ft_byte; 9017 9018 ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 9019 return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0; 9020 } 9021 9022 /** 9023 * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function 9024 * @f: NAN function that should be freed 9025 * 9026 * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members. 9027 */ 9028 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f); 9029 9030 /** 9031 * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters 9032 * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is 9033 * %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber. 9034 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery 9035 * result. 9036 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up. 9037 * @inst_id: the local instance id 9038 * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function 9039 * @addr: the MAC address of the peer 9040 * @info_len: the length of the &info 9041 * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any) 9042 * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function 9043 */ 9044 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params { 9045 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 9046 u8 inst_id; 9047 u8 peer_inst_id; 9048 const u8 *addr; 9049 u8 info_len; 9050 const u8 *info; 9051 u64 cookie; 9052 }; 9053 9054 /** 9055 * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function. 9056 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 9057 * @match: match notification parameters 9058 * @gfp: allocation flags 9059 * 9060 * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This 9061 * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that 9062 * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received. 9063 */ 9064 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 9065 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp); 9066 9067 /** 9068 * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination. 9069 * 9070 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 9071 * @inst_id: the local instance id 9072 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*) 9073 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier 9074 * @gfp: allocation flags 9075 * 9076 * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated. 9077 */ 9078 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 9079 u8 inst_id, 9080 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason, 9081 u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp); 9082 9083 /* ethtool helper */ 9084 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info); 9085 9086 /** 9087 * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication 9088 * @netdev: network device 9089 * @params: External authentication parameters 9090 * @gfp: allocation flags 9091 * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error 9092 */ 9093 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev, 9094 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params, 9095 gfp_t gfp); 9096 9097 /** 9098 * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data 9099 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 9100 * @req: the original measurement request 9101 * @result: the result data 9102 * @gfp: allocation flags 9103 */ 9104 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 9105 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 9106 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result, 9107 gfp_t gfp); 9108 9109 /** 9110 * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed 9111 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 9112 * @req: the original measurement request 9113 * @gfp: allocation flags 9114 * 9115 * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this 9116 * the request pointer will no longer be valid. 9117 */ 9118 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 9119 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 9120 gfp_t gfp); 9121 9122 /** 9123 * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed 9124 * @wiphy: the wiphy 9125 * @iftype: interface type 9126 * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1' 9127 * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces 9128 * 9129 * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API 9130 * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when 9131 * check_swif is '1'. 9132 */ 9133 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 9134 bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif); 9135 9136 9137 /** 9138 * cfg80211_assoc_comeback - notification of association that was 9139 * temporarily rejected with a comeback 9140 * @netdev: network device 9141 * @ap_addr: AP (MLD) address that rejected the association 9142 * @timeout: timeout interval value TUs. 9143 * 9144 * this function may sleep. the caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 9145 */ 9146 void cfg80211_assoc_comeback(struct net_device *netdev, 9147 const u8 *ap_addr, u32 timeout); 9148 9149 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */ 9150 9151 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */ 9152 9153 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...) \ 9154 dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9155 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9156 dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9157 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9158 dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9159 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9160 dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9161 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9162 dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9163 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9164 dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9165 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9166 dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9167 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9168 dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9169 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9170 dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9171 9172 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9173 dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9174 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9175 dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9176 9177 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9178 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args) 9179 9180 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9181 dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9182 9183 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG) 9184 #define wiphy_vdbg wiphy_dbg 9185 #else 9186 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9187 ({ \ 9188 if (0) \ 9189 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args); \ 9190 0; \ 9191 }) 9192 #endif 9193 9194 /* 9195 * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference 9196 * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the 9197 * file/line information and a backtrace. 9198 */ 9199 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9200 WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args); 9201 9202 /** 9203 * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space 9204 * @netdev: network device 9205 * @owe_info: peer's owe info 9206 * @gfp: allocation flags 9207 */ 9208 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev, 9209 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info, 9210 gfp_t gfp); 9211 9212 /** 9213 * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries 9214 * @wiphy: the wiphy 9215 */ 9216 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy); 9217 9218 /** 9219 * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event 9220 * @dev: network device 9221 * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify 9222 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens 9223 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of 9224 */ 9225 int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev, 9226 enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count, 9227 u64 color_bitmap); 9228 9229 /** 9230 * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision 9231 * @dev: network device 9232 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of 9233 */ 9234 static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev, 9235 u64 color_bitmap) 9236 { 9237 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION, 9238 0, color_bitmap); 9239 } 9240 9241 /** 9242 * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start 9243 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched 9244 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens 9245 * 9246 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started. 9247 */ 9248 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev, 9249 u8 count) 9250 { 9251 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED, 9252 count, 0); 9253 } 9254 9255 /** 9256 * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort 9257 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched 9258 * 9259 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted. 9260 */ 9261 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev) 9262 { 9263 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED, 9264 0, 0); 9265 } 9266 9267 /** 9268 * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion 9269 * @dev: the device on which the color was switched 9270 * 9271 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed. 9272 */ 9273 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev) 9274 { 9275 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, 9276 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED, 9277 0, 0); 9278 } 9279 9280 /** 9281 * cfg80211_valid_disable_subchannel_bitmap - validate puncturing bitmap 9282 * @bitmap: bitmap to be validated 9283 * @chandef: channel definition 9284 * 9285 * Validate the puncturing bitmap. 9286 * 9287 * Return: %true if the bitmap is valid. %false otherwise. 9288 */ 9289 bool cfg80211_valid_disable_subchannel_bitmap(u16 *bitmap, 9290 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 9291 9292 /** 9293 * cfg80211_links_removed - Notify about removed STA MLD setup links. 9294 * @dev: network device. 9295 * @link_mask: BIT mask of removed STA MLD setup link IDs. 9296 * 9297 * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace about removed STA MLD setup links due to 9298 * AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with Multi-Link 9299 * reconfiguration. Note that it's not valid to remove all links, in this 9300 * case disconnect instead. 9301 * Also note that the wdev mutex must be held. 9302 */ 9303 void cfg80211_links_removed(struct net_device *dev, u16 link_mask); 9304 9305 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_DEBUGFS 9306 /** 9307 * wiphy_locked_debugfs_read - do a locked read in debugfs 9308 * @wiphy: the wiphy to use 9309 * @file: the file being read 9310 * @buf: the buffer to fill and then read from 9311 * @bufsize: size of the buffer 9312 * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy to 9313 * @count: read count 9314 * @ppos: read position 9315 * @handler: the read handler to call (under wiphy lock) 9316 * @data: additional data to pass to the read handler 9317 */ 9318 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_read(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file, 9319 char *buf, size_t bufsize, 9320 char __user *userbuf, size_t count, 9321 loff_t *ppos, 9322 ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 9323 struct file *file, 9324 char *buf, 9325 size_t bufsize, 9326 void *data), 9327 void *data); 9328 9329 /** 9330 * wiphy_locked_debugfs_write - do a locked write in debugfs 9331 * @wiphy: the wiphy to use 9332 * @file: the file being written to 9333 * @buf: the buffer to copy the user data to 9334 * @bufsize: size of the buffer 9335 * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy from 9336 * @count: read count 9337 * @handler: the write handler to call (under wiphy lock) 9338 * @data: additional data to pass to the write handler 9339 */ 9340 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_write(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file, 9341 char *buf, size_t bufsize, 9342 const char __user *userbuf, size_t count, 9343 ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 9344 struct file *file, 9345 char *buf, 9346 size_t count, 9347 void *data), 9348 void *data); 9349 #endif 9350 9351 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */ 9352